3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 7.9.3f (GNU Emacs 24.3)
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
46 @c a key but no command
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
255 @subsubheading \text\
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual.''
280 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
282 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
286 @title The Org Manual
288 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
289 @author by Carsten Dominik
290 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
292 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
294 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
298 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
302 @c FIXME These hand-written next,prev,up node pointers make editing a lot
303 @c harder. There should be no need for them, makeinfo can do it
304 @c automatically for any document with a normal structure.
305 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
312 * Introduction:: Getting started
313 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
314 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
315 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
316 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
317 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
318 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
319 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
320 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
321 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
322 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
323 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
324 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
325 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
326 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
327 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
328 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
329 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
330 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
331 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
332 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
333 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
334 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
337 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
341 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
342 * Installation:: Installing Org
343 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
344 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
345 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
349 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
350 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
351 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
352 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
353 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
354 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
355 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
356 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
357 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
358 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
359 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
363 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
364 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
365 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
366 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
367 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
368 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
372 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
373 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
374 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
375 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
376 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
377 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
378 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
379 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
380 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
384 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
385 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
386 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
387 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
388 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
389 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
390 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
391 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
395 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
399 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
400 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
401 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
402 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
403 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
404 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
406 Extended use of TODO keywords
408 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
409 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
410 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
411 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
412 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
413 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
414 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
418 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
419 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
420 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
424 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
425 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
426 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
428 Properties and columns
430 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
431 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
432 * Property searches:: Matching property values
433 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
434 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
435 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
439 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
440 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
441 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
445 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
446 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
450 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
451 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
452 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
453 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
454 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
455 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
456 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
460 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
461 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
463 Deadlines and scheduling
465 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
466 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
470 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
471 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
472 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
474 Capture - Refile - Archive
476 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
477 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
478 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
479 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
480 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
481 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
485 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
486 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
487 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
491 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
492 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
493 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
497 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
498 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
502 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
503 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
504 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
505 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
506 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
507 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
508 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
509 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
511 The built-in agenda views
513 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
514 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
515 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
516 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
517 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
518 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
520 Presentation and sorting
522 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
523 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
524 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
528 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
529 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
530 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
532 Markup for rich export
534 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
535 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
536 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
537 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
538 * Index entries:: Making an index
539 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
540 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
542 Structural markup elements
544 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
545 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
546 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
547 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
549 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
550 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
551 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
552 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
553 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
557 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
558 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
559 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
560 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
561 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
565 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
566 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
567 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
568 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
569 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
570 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
571 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
572 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
573 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
574 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
575 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
576 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
580 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
581 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
582 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
583 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
584 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
585 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
586 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
587 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
588 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
589 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
591 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
593 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
594 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
595 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
596 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
597 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
598 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
602 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
603 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
604 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
605 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
606 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
607 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
609 OpenDocument Text export
611 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
612 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
613 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
614 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
615 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
616 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
617 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
618 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
619 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
620 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
621 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
623 Math formatting in ODT export
625 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
626 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
628 Advanced topics in ODT export
630 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
631 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
632 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
633 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
634 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
638 * Configuration:: Defining projects
639 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
640 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
641 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
645 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
646 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
647 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
648 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
649 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
650 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
651 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
652 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
656 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
657 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
659 Working with source code
661 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
662 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
663 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
664 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
665 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
666 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
667 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
668 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
669 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
670 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
671 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
672 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
676 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
677 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
679 Using header arguments
681 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
682 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
683 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
684 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
685 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
686 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
688 Specific header arguments
690 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
691 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
692 be collected and handled
693 * file:: Specify a path for file output
694 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
695 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
696 directory for code block execution
697 * exports:: Export code and/or results
698 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
699 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
700 files during tangling
701 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
703 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
705 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
706 expansion during tangling
707 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
708 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
709 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
710 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
711 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
712 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
713 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
714 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
715 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
716 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
717 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
718 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
722 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
723 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
724 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
725 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
726 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
727 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
728 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
729 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
730 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
731 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
732 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
734 Interaction with other packages
736 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
737 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
741 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
742 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
743 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
744 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
745 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
746 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
747 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
748 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
749 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
750 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
752 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
754 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
755 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
756 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
757 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
761 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
762 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
763 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
768 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
769 @chapter Introduction
773 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
774 * Installation:: Installing Org
775 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
776 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
777 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
780 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
784 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
785 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
787 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
788 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
789 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
790 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
791 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
792 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
793 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
794 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
795 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
796 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
797 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
798 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
799 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
802 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
803 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
804 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
806 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
807 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
808 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
810 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
811 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
812 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
813 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
814 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
815 the minor Orgstruct mode.
817 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
818 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
819 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
820 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
824 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
825 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
826 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
827 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
828 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
829 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
830 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
831 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
832 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
836 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
837 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
838 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
839 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
841 @cindex print edition
842 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
843 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
849 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
850 @section Installation
854 Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't need
855 to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top
856 of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it:
859 @item By using Emacs package system.
860 @item By downloading Org as an archive.
861 @item By using Org's git repository.
864 We @b{strongly recommend} to stick to a single installation method.
866 @subsubheading Using Emacs packaging system
868 Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install
869 Elisp libraries. You can install Org with @kbd{M-x package-install RET org}.
870 To make sure your Org configuration is well taken into account, initialize
871 the package system with @code{(package-initialize)} before setting any Org
872 option. If you want to use Org's package repository, check out the
873 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}.
875 @subsubheading Downloading Org as an archive
877 You can download Org latest release from @uref{http://orgmode.org/, Org's
878 website}. In this case, make sure you set the load-path correctly in your
882 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
885 The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included
886 in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the @file{contrib} directory to your
890 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
893 Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system.
894 Run @code{make help} to list compilation and installation options.
896 @subsubheading Using Org's git repository
898 You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this:
902 $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git
906 Note that in this case, @code{make autoloads} is mandatory: it defines Org's
907 version in @file{org-version.el} and Org's autoloads in
908 @file{org-loaddefs.el}.
910 Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method above.
912 You can also compile with @code{make}, generate the documentation with
913 @code{make doc}, create a local configuration with @code{make config} and
914 install Org with @code{make install}. Please run @code{make help} to get
915 the list of compilation/installation options.
917 For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org
918 Build System page on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html,
921 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
926 @cindex global key bindings
927 @cindex key bindings, global
930 @findex org-store-link
933 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
934 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
938 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
941 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in
942 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
943 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
945 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
946 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
948 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
949 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
950 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
951 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
954 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
955 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
956 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
957 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
960 @cindex Org mode, turning on
961 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
962 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
966 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
969 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
970 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
971 the file's name is. See also the variable
972 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
974 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
975 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
976 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
977 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
979 (transient-mark-mode 1)
981 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
982 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
983 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
985 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
992 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
993 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
994 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
995 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
996 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
997 moderators have to do.}.
999 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1000 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1001 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1002 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1003 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1004 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1005 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1007 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1009 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1010 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1011 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1013 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1014 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1015 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1016 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1017 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1020 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1023 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1024 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1025 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1029 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1031 ;; activate debugging
1032 (setq debug-on-error t
1036 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1037 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1038 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1041 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1042 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1046 @item What exactly did you do?
1047 @item What did you expect to happen?
1048 @item What happened instead?
1050 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1052 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1054 @cindex backtrace of an error
1055 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1056 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1057 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1058 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1059 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1063 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1064 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1067 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1070 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1073 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1074 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1076 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1077 document the steps you take.
1079 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1080 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1081 attach it to your bug report.
1084 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1085 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1087 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1089 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1090 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1095 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1099 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1100 meaning are written with all capitals.
1103 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1104 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1107 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1108 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1109 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1110 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1111 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1114 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1120 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1121 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1122 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1124 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1125 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1126 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1127 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1128 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1129 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1130 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1131 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1132 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1133 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1135 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1136 @chapter Document structure
1137 @cindex document structure
1138 @cindex structure of document
1140 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1141 edit the structure of the document.
1144 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1145 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1146 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1147 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1148 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1149 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1150 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1151 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1152 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1153 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1154 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1157 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1160 @cindex Outline mode
1162 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1163 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1164 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1165 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1166 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1167 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1168 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1169 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1171 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1174 @cindex outline tree
1175 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1176 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1177 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1179 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1180 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1181 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1182 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1183 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1184 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1187 * Top level headline
1194 * Another top level headline
1197 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1198 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1199 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1201 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1202 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1203 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1204 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1205 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1206 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1208 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1209 @section Visibility cycling
1210 @cindex cycling, visibility
1211 @cindex visibility cycling
1212 @cindex trees, visibility
1213 @cindex show hidden text
1216 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1217 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1218 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1220 @cindex subtree visibility states
1221 @cindex subtree cycling
1222 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1223 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1224 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1226 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1227 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1230 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1231 '-----------------------------------'
1234 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1235 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1236 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1237 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1238 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1239 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1240 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1241 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1243 @cindex global visibility states
1244 @cindex global cycling
1245 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1246 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1247 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1248 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1249 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1250 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1253 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1254 '--------------------------------------'
1257 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1258 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1259 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1261 @cindex show all, command
1262 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1263 Show all, including drawers.
1264 @cindex revealing context
1265 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1266 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1267 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1268 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1269 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1270 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1271 entire subtree of the parent.
1272 @cindex show branches, command
1273 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1274 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1275 @cindex show children, command
1276 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1277 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1278 expose all children down to level N@.
1279 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1280 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1283 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1286 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1288 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1289 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1290 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1291 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1292 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1293 the previously used indirect buffer.
1294 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1295 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1298 @vindex org-startup-folded
1299 @vindex org-agenda-inhibit-startup
1300 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1301 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1302 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1303 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1305 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1306 OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1307 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1308 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1315 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1318 The startup visibility options are ignored when the file is open for the
1319 first time during the agenda generation: if you want the agenda to honor
1320 the startup visibility, set @code{org-agenda-inhibit-startup} to nil.
1322 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1324 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1325 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1326 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1329 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1330 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1331 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1335 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1337 @cindex motion, between headlines
1338 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1339 @cindex headline navigation
1340 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1343 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1345 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1347 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1348 Next heading same level.
1349 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1350 Previous heading same level.
1351 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1352 Backward to higher level heading.
1353 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1354 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1355 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1356 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1357 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1359 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1360 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1361 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1362 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1363 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1364 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1365 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1367 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1370 @vindex org-goto-interface
1372 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1375 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1376 @section Structure editing
1377 @cindex structure editing
1378 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1379 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1380 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1381 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1382 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1383 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1384 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1385 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1386 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1389 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1390 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1391 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1392 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1393 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1394 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1395 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1396 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1397 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1398 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1399 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.,
1400 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1401 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1402 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1403 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1404 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1405 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1406 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1407 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1408 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1409 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1410 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1411 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1412 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1414 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1415 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1416 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1417 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1418 to the initial level.
1419 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1420 Promote current heading by one level.
1421 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1422 Demote current heading by one level.
1423 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1424 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1425 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1426 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1427 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1428 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1430 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1431 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1432 @orgcmd{M-h,org-mark-element}
1433 Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent elements
1434 of the one just marked. E.g., hitting @key{M-h} on a paragraph will mark it,
1435 hitting @key{M-h} immediately again will mark the next one.
1436 @orgcmd{C-c @@,org-mark-subtree}
1437 Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent subtrees
1438 of the same level than the marked subtree.
1439 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1440 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1441 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1442 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1443 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1444 sequential subtrees.
1445 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1446 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1447 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1448 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1449 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1450 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1451 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1452 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1453 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1454 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1455 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1456 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1457 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1458 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1459 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1460 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1461 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1463 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1464 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1465 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1466 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1467 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1468 more details, see the docstring of the command
1469 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1470 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1471 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1472 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1473 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1474 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1475 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1476 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1477 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1478 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1479 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1480 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1481 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1482 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1483 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1484 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1485 Narrow buffer to current block.
1486 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1487 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1488 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1489 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1490 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1491 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1492 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1493 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1494 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1497 @cindex region, active
1498 @cindex active region
1499 @cindex transient mark mode
1500 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1501 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1502 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1503 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1504 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1505 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1509 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1510 @section Sparse trees
1511 @cindex sparse trees
1512 @cindex trees, sparse
1513 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1514 @cindex occur, command
1516 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1517 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1518 @vindex org-show-siblings
1519 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1520 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1521 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1522 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1523 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1524 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1525 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1526 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1527 and you will see immediately how it works.
1529 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1530 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1533 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1534 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1535 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1536 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1537 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1538 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1539 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1540 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1541 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1542 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1543 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1544 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1545 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1546 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1547 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1548 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1549 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1550 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1555 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1556 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1557 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1558 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1559 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1563 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1564 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1567 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1568 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1570 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1571 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1574 @cindex printing sparse trees
1575 @cindex visible text, printing
1576 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1577 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1578 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1579 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1580 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1581 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1583 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1584 @section Plain lists
1586 @cindex lists, plain
1587 @cindex lists, ordered
1588 @cindex ordered lists
1590 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1591 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1592 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1593 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1595 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1598 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1599 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1600 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1601 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1602 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1603 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1606 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1607 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1608 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1609 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1610 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1611 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1612 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1613 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1614 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1615 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1616 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1617 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1618 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1619 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1621 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1622 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1626 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1627 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1628 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1629 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1630 than its bullet/number.
1632 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1633 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1634 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1635 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1636 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1640 ** Lord of the Rings
1641 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1642 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1643 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1644 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1645 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1646 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1648 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1649 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1650 Important actors in this film are:
1651 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1652 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1653 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1657 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1658 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1659 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1660 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1661 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1662 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1663 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1665 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1666 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1667 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1668 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1669 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1670 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1671 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1673 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1674 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1675 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1676 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1677 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1678 to disable them individually.
1681 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1682 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1683 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1684 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1685 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1686 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1687 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1688 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1689 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1690 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1691 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1692 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1693 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1694 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1695 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1696 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1697 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1698 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1699 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1700 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1701 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1702 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1707 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1709 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1710 @kindex S-@key{down}
1713 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1714 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1715 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1716 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1717 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1718 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1719 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1720 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1723 @kindex M-@key{down}
1726 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1727 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1728 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1730 @kindex M-@key{left}
1731 @kindex M-@key{right}
1734 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1735 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1736 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1739 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1740 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1741 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1742 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1743 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1746 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1747 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1748 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1749 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1752 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1753 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1754 consistency in the whole list.
1756 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1758 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1759 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1760 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1761 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1762 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1763 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1764 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1765 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1766 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1769 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1770 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1773 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1774 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1776 @kindex S-@key{left}
1777 @kindex S-@key{right}
1779 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1780 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1781 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1782 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1785 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1786 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1789 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1793 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1796 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1798 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1799 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1800 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1801 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1802 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1806 ** This is a headline
1807 Still outside the drawer
1809 This is inside the drawer.
1814 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1815 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1816 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1817 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1818 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1819 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1821 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1822 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1823 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1824 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1825 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1826 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1827 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1828 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1833 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1836 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1839 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1840 @cindex blocks, folding
1841 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1842 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1843 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1844 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1845 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1846 or on a per-file basis by using
1848 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1849 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1851 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1852 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1855 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1859 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1860 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1861 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1862 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e., a footnote is
1863 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1864 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1865 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1866 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1869 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1871 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1874 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1875 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1876 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1877 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1878 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1882 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1883 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1886 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1887 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1888 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1889 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1891 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1892 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1893 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1894 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1897 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1898 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1899 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1900 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1903 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1908 The footnote action command.
1910 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1911 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1913 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1914 @vindex org-footnote-section
1915 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1916 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1917 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1918 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1919 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1920 separately into the location determined by the variable
1921 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1923 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1926 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1927 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1928 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1929 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1930 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1931 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1932 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1933 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1934 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1935 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1936 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1937 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1938 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1939 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1940 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1941 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1942 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1945 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1946 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1947 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1952 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1953 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1954 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1958 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1959 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1960 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1963 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1964 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1965 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1966 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1968 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1969 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1970 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1971 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1972 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1975 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1976 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1979 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1980 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1981 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1982 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1983 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1984 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1985 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1988 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1991 @cindex editing tables
1993 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1994 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1995 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1998 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1999 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2000 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2001 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2002 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2003 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2006 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2007 @section The built-in table editor
2008 @cindex table editor, built-in
2010 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2011 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2012 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2013 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2014 might look like this:
2017 | Name | Phone | Age |
2018 |-------+-------+-----|
2019 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2020 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2023 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2024 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2025 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2026 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2027 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2028 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2029 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2030 create the above table, you would only type
2037 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2038 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2039 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2041 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2042 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2043 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2044 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2045 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2046 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2047 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2048 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2049 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2050 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2053 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2054 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2055 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2056 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2057 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2058 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2059 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2060 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2061 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2063 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2064 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2065 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2067 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2068 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2069 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2071 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2072 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2075 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2076 Re-align, move to previous field.
2078 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2079 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2080 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2081 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2083 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2084 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2085 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2086 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2088 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2089 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2090 Move the current column left/right.
2092 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2093 Kill the current column.
2095 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2096 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2098 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2099 Move the current row up/down.
2101 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2102 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2104 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2105 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2106 created below the current one.
2108 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2109 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2110 is created above the current line.
2112 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2113 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2116 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2117 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2118 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2119 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2120 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2121 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2122 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2123 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2124 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2125 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2127 @tsubheading{Regions}
2128 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2129 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2130 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2131 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2133 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2134 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2135 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2137 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2138 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2139 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2140 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2141 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2144 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2145 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2146 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2147 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2148 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2149 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2150 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2153 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2154 @cindex formula, in tables
2155 @cindex calculations, in tables
2156 @cindex region, active
2157 @cindex active region
2158 @cindex transient mark mode
2159 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2160 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2161 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2162 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2164 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2165 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2166 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2167 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2168 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2169 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2170 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2171 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2172 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2174 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2175 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2176 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2177 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2178 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2179 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2180 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2181 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2182 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2184 @item M-x org-table-import
2185 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2186 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2187 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2188 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2189 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2190 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2192 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2193 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2194 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2195 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2197 @item M-x org-table-export
2198 @findex org-table-export
2199 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2200 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2201 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2202 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2203 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2204 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2205 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2206 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2207 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2208 detailed description.
2211 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2212 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2216 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2219 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2220 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2222 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2223 @section Column width and alignment
2224 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2225 @cindex alignment in tables
2227 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2228 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2229 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2231 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2232 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2233 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2234 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2235 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2236 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2237 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2241 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2243 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2244 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2245 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2246 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2247 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2252 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2253 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2254 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2255 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2256 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2257 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2260 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2261 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2262 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2263 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2264 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2265 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2266 on a per-file basis with:
2273 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2274 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2275 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2276 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2277 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2279 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2280 automatically when exporting the document.
2282 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2283 @section Column groups
2284 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2286 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2287 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2288 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2289 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2290 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2291 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2292 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2293 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2294 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2295 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2296 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2299 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2300 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2301 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2302 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2303 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2304 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2305 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2306 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2309 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2310 every vertical line you would like to have:
2313 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2314 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2318 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2319 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2321 @cindex minor mode for tables
2323 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2324 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2325 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2326 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2327 example in Message mode, use
2330 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2333 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2334 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2335 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2336 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2337 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2339 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2340 @section The spreadsheet
2341 @cindex calculations, in tables
2342 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2343 @cindex @file{calc} package
2345 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2346 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2347 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2348 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2349 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2350 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2351 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2352 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2353 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2356 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2357 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2358 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2359 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2360 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2361 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2362 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2363 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2364 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2367 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2368 @subsection References
2371 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2372 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2373 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2374 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2375 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2377 @subsubheading Field references
2378 @cindex field references
2379 @cindex references, to fields
2381 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2382 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2383 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2384 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2385 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2386 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2387 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2388 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2389 representation that looks like this:
2391 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2394 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2395 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2396 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2397 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2398 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2399 column from the right.
2401 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2402 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2403 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2404 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2405 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2406 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2407 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2408 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2409 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2410 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2411 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2412 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2413 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2414 after the third hline in the table.
2416 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2417 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2418 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2421 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2422 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2423 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2424 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2425 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2426 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2428 Here are a few examples:
2431 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2432 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2433 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2434 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2435 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2436 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2439 @subsubheading Range references
2440 @cindex range references
2441 @cindex references, to ranges
2443 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2444 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2445 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2446 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2447 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2448 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2451 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2452 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2453 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2454 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2455 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{in the first row up, 3 fields from 2 columns on the left}
2456 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2459 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2460 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2461 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2462 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2463 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2465 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2466 @cindex field coordinates
2467 @cindex coordinates, of field
2468 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2469 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2471 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2472 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2473 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2474 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2477 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2478 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2479 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2482 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2483 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2484 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2487 @subsubheading Named references
2488 @cindex named references
2489 @cindex references, named
2490 @cindex name, of column or field
2491 @cindex constants, in calculations
2494 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2495 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2496 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2497 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2501 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2505 @vindex constants-unit-system
2506 @pindex constants.el
2507 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2508 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2509 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2510 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2511 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2512 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2513 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2514 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2515 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2516 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2517 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2518 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2519 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2520 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2523 @subsubheading Remote references
2524 @cindex remote references
2525 @cindex references, remote
2526 @cindex references, to a different table
2527 @cindex name, of column or field
2528 @cindex constants, in calculations
2531 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2532 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2535 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2539 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2540 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2541 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2542 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2543 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2546 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2547 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2548 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2549 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2551 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2552 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2553 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2554 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2555 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2556 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2557 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2558 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2559 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2560 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2561 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2563 @cindex format specifier
2564 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2565 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2566 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2567 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2568 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2569 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2570 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2571 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2572 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2575 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2576 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2577 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2578 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2579 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2580 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2581 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2582 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2583 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2588 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2589 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2590 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2591 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2592 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2593 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2594 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2595 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2596 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2600 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2601 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2602 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2603 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2604 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2605 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2606 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2607 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2608 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2609 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2610 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2613 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2616 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2619 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2620 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2622 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2623 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2624 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2626 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2627 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2630 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2631 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2632 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2633 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2635 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2636 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2637 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2638 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2639 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2640 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2641 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2642 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2643 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2644 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2646 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2647 computations in Lisp:
2650 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2651 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2652 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2654 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1--4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2655 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2658 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2659 @subsection Durations and time values
2660 @cindex Duration, computing
2661 @cindex Time, computing
2662 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2664 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2665 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2669 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2670 |---------+----------+----------|
2671 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2672 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2673 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2677 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2678 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2679 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2680 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2681 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2682 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2685 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2686 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2688 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2689 @subsection Field and range formulas
2690 @cindex field formula
2691 @cindex range formula
2692 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2693 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2695 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2696 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2697 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2698 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2699 current field will be replaced with the result.
2702 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2703 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2704 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2705 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2706 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2707 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2708 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2709 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2710 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2711 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2712 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2714 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2718 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2719 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2720 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2721 it to the current field, and stores it.
2724 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2725 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2726 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2727 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2732 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2733 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2735 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2738 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2739 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2741 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2744 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2745 @subsection Column formulas
2746 @cindex column formula
2747 @cindex formula, for table column
2749 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2750 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2751 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2752 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2753 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2754 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2755 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2757 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2758 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2759 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2760 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2761 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2762 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2763 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2764 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2765 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2766 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2768 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2772 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2773 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2774 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2775 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2776 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2777 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2780 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2781 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2782 @cindex formula editing
2783 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2785 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2786 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2787 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2788 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2789 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2790 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2791 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2792 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2795 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2796 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2797 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2798 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2799 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2800 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2801 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2802 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2803 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2804 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2805 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2807 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2809 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2810 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2811 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2813 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2815 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2816 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2817 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2818 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2819 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2820 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2821 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2822 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2823 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2825 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2826 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2827 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2828 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2829 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2830 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2831 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2832 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2833 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2834 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2835 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2836 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2837 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2838 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2839 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2841 @kindex S-@key{down}
2842 @kindex S-@key{left}
2843 @kindex S-@key{right}
2844 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2845 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2846 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2847 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2848 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2849 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2850 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2851 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2852 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2853 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2855 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2856 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2858 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2860 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2864 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2865 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2866 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2867 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2868 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2871 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2872 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2873 recalculation commands in the table.
2875 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2876 @cindex formula debugging
2877 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2878 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2879 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2880 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2881 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2882 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2883 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2885 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2886 @subsection Updating the table
2887 @cindex recomputing table fields
2888 @cindex updating, table
2890 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2891 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2892 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2894 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2898 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2899 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2900 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2906 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2907 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2909 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2910 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2911 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2912 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2913 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2914 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2915 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2916 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2917 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2918 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2922 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2923 @subsection Advanced features
2925 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2926 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2927 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2928 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2929 special marking characters.
2932 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2933 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2934 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2935 change all marks in the region.
2938 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2939 makes use of these features:
2943 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2944 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2945 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2946 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2947 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2948 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2949 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2950 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2951 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2952 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2953 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
2954 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2955 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2956 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2957 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2961 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2962 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2963 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2964 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2967 @cindex marking characters, tables
2968 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2971 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2972 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2974 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2975 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2976 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2977 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2979 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2982 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2983 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2984 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2985 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2988 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2989 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2990 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2991 lines will be left alone by this command.
2993 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2994 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2995 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2997 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2998 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3001 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3002 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3005 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3006 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3007 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3012 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3013 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3014 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3015 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3016 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3017 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3018 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3019 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3020 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3021 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3022 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3026 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3028 @cindex graph, in tables
3029 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3032 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3033 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3034 @uref{http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode}. To see this in action, ensure
3035 that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then
3036 call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3040 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3041 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3042 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3043 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3044 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3045 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3046 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3047 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3051 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3052 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3053 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3054 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3055 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3056 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3058 @subsubheading Plot Options
3062 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3065 Specify the title of the plot.
3068 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3071 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3072 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3073 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3077 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3080 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3081 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3082 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3085 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3088 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3092 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3095 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3096 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3099 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3100 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3103 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3104 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3105 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3106 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3107 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3111 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3115 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3116 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3119 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3120 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3121 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3122 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3123 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3124 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3125 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3126 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3129 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3130 @section Link format
3132 @cindex format, of links
3134 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3135 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3138 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3142 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3143 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3144 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3145 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3146 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3147 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3148 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3149 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3152 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3153 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3154 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3155 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3156 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3157 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3158 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3160 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3161 @section Internal links
3162 @cindex internal links
3163 @cindex links, internal
3164 @cindex targets, for links
3166 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3167 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3168 current file. The most important case is a link like
3169 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3170 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3171 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3172 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3175 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3176 lead to a text search in the current file.
3178 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3179 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3180 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3181 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3182 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3183 comment line. For example
3189 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3190 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3191 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3192 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3195 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3196 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3197 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3198 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3199 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3200 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3201 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3203 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3204 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3205 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3209 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3212 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3213 @subsection Radio targets
3214 @cindex radio targets
3215 @cindex targets, radio
3216 @cindex links, radio targets
3218 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3219 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3220 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3221 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3222 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3223 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3224 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3225 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3226 cursor on or at a target.
3228 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3229 @section External links
3230 @cindex links, external
3231 @cindex external links
3232 @cindex links, external
3240 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3242 @cindex USENET links
3247 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3248 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3249 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3250 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3251 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3254 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3255 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3256 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3257 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3258 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3259 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3260 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3261 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3262 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3263 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3264 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3265 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3266 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3267 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3268 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3269 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3270 will be queried to create it.}
3271 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3272 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3273 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3274 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3275 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3276 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3277 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3278 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3279 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3280 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3281 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3282 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3283 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3284 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3285 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3286 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3287 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3288 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3289 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3290 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3291 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3292 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3293 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3294 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3295 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3296 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3299 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3301 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3302 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3303 format}), for example:
3306 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3310 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3311 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3312 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3314 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3316 @cindex square brackets, around links
3317 @cindex plain text external links
3318 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3319 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3320 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3321 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3323 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3324 @section Handling links
3325 @cindex links, handling
3327 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3328 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3331 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3332 @cindex storing links
3333 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3334 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3335 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3336 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3339 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3340 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3341 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3342 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3343 removed from the link and result in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
3344 timestamp in the headline.}.
3346 @vindex org-id-link-to-org-use-id
3347 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3348 @cindex property, ID
3349 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3350 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3351 @code{org-id-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will
3352 be created and/or used to construct a link@footnote{The library @code{org-id}
3353 must first be loaded, either through @code{org-customize} by enabling
3354 @code{id} in @code{org-modules} , or by adding @code{(require 'org-id)} in
3355 your @file{.emacs}.}. So using this command in Org
3356 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3357 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3358 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3361 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3362 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3363 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3364 constructed from the author and the subject.
3366 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3367 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3369 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3370 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3373 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3374 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3375 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3376 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3377 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3380 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3381 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3382 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3383 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3384 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3385 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3386 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3389 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3390 entry referenced by the current line.
3393 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3394 @cindex link completion
3395 @cindex completion, of links
3396 @cindex inserting links
3397 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3398 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3399 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3400 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3401 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3402 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3403 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3404 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3405 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3406 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3407 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3408 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3409 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3410 becomes the default description.
3412 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3413 All links stored during the
3414 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3415 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3417 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3418 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3419 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3420 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3421 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3422 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3423 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3424 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3425 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3427 @cindex file name completion
3428 @cindex completion, of file names
3429 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3430 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3431 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3432 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3433 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3434 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3435 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3436 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3438 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3439 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3440 link and description parts of the link.
3442 @cindex following links
3443 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3444 @vindex org-file-apps
3445 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3446 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3447 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3448 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3449 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3450 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3451 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3452 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3453 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3454 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3455 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3456 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3457 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3458 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3459 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3460 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3463 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3464 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3471 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3472 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3476 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3477 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3478 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3479 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3481 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3482 @cindex inlining images
3483 @cindex images, inlining
3484 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3485 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3486 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3487 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3488 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3489 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3490 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3491 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3492 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3493 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3494 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3496 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3497 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3499 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3500 @cindex links, returning to
3501 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3502 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3503 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3504 previously recorded positions.
3506 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3507 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3508 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3509 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3510 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3511 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3513 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3515 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3516 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3520 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3521 @section Using links outside Org
3523 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3524 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3525 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3529 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3530 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3533 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3534 @section Link abbreviations
3535 @cindex link abbreviations
3536 @cindex abbreviation, links
3538 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3539 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3540 abbreviated link looks like this
3543 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3547 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3548 where the tag is optional.
3549 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3550 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3551 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3552 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3556 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3557 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3558 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3559 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3560 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3561 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3562 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3566 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3567 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3568 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3569 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3570 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3572 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3573 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3575 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3576 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3578 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3579 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3580 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3581 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3582 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3583 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3584 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3586 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3587 can define them in the file with
3591 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3592 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3596 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3597 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3598 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3599 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3600 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3602 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3603 @section Search options in file links
3604 @cindex search option in file links
3605 @cindex file links, searching
3607 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3608 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3609 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3610 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3611 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3612 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3613 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3614 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3616 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3617 link, together with an explanation:
3620 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3621 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3622 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3623 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3624 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3631 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3632 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3633 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3634 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3637 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3639 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3641 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3642 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3643 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3644 sparse tree with the matches.
3645 @c If the target file is a directory,
3646 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3649 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3650 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3651 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3652 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3654 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3655 @section Custom Searches
3656 @cindex custom search strings
3657 @cindex search strings, custom
3659 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3660 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3661 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3662 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3663 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3666 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3667 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3668 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3669 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3670 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3671 to be added to the hook variables
3672 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3673 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3674 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3675 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3676 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3678 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3682 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3683 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3684 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3685 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3686 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3687 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3688 item emerged is always present.
3690 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3691 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3692 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3695 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3696 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3697 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3698 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3699 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3700 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3703 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3704 @section Basic TODO functionality
3706 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3707 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3710 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3714 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3717 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3718 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3719 @vindex org-use-fast-todo-selection
3721 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3724 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3725 '--------------------------------'
3728 If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see @ref{Fast access to TODO
3729 states}), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through the fast selection
3730 interface; this is the default behavior when
3731 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is @code{non-nil}.
3733 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and agenda
3734 buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3736 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3737 When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific keyword using
3738 completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO states with no prompt. When
3739 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is set to @code{prefix}, use the fast
3740 selection interface.
3742 @kindex S-@key{right}
3743 @kindex S-@key{left}
3744 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3745 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3746 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3747 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3748 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3749 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3750 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3751 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3752 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3753 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3754 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3755 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3756 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3757 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3758 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3759 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3760 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3761 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3762 both un-done and done.
3763 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3764 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3765 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3766 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3767 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3768 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3769 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3770 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3774 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3775 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3776 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3778 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3779 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3780 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3782 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3783 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3784 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3785 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3786 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3789 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3790 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3793 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3794 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3795 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3796 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3797 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3798 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3799 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3802 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3803 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3804 @cindex TODO workflow
3805 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3807 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3808 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3809 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3813 (setq org-todo-keywords
3814 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3817 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3818 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3819 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3821 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3822 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3823 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
3824 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3825 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
3826 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3827 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3828 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3829 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3830 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3831 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3833 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3834 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3836 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3837 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3839 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3840 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3841 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3842 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3843 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3844 be set up like this:
3847 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3850 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3851 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3852 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3853 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3854 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3855 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3856 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3857 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3858 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3859 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3860 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3861 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3862 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3863 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3865 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3866 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3867 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3869 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3870 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3871 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3872 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3873 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3877 (setq org-todo-keywords
3878 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3879 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3880 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3883 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3884 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3885 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3886 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3887 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3888 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3889 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3892 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3893 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3894 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3895 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3896 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3897 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3898 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3899 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3900 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3901 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3902 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3903 @kindex S-@key{right}
3904 @kindex S-@key{left}
3907 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3908 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3909 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3910 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3911 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3914 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3915 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3917 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3918 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3919 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3920 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3921 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3924 (setq org-todo-keywords
3925 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3926 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3927 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3930 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3931 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3932 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3933 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3934 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3935 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3936 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3937 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3939 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3940 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3941 @cindex keyword options
3942 @cindex per-file keywords
3947 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3948 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3949 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3950 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3951 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3955 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3957 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3958 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3960 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3963 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3967 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3971 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3973 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3974 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3976 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3977 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3978 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3979 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3980 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3981 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3982 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3983 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3984 for the current buffer.}.
3986 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3987 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3988 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3990 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3991 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3992 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3993 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3994 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3995 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3996 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3997 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3998 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4002 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4003 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4004 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4008 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4009 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4010 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4011 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4012 foreground or a background color.
4014 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4015 @subsection TODO dependencies
4016 @cindex TODO dependencies
4017 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4019 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4020 @cindex property, ORDERED
4021 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4022 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4023 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4024 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4025 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4026 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4027 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4028 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4029 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4033 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4042 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4043 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4047 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4048 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4049 @cindex property, ORDERED
4050 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4051 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4052 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4053 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4054 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4055 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4056 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4059 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4060 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4061 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4062 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4064 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4065 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4066 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4067 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4068 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4069 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4071 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4072 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4073 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4076 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4077 @section Progress logging
4078 @cindex progress logging
4079 @cindex logging, of progress
4081 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4082 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4083 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable; settings can be on a
4084 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4085 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4089 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4090 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4091 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4094 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4095 @subsection Closing items
4097 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4098 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4099 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4102 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4106 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4107 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4108 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4109 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4110 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4111 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4114 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4118 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4119 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4121 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4122 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4123 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4124 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4126 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4127 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4128 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4130 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4131 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4132 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4133 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4134 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4135 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4136 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4137 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4138 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4139 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4140 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4141 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4142 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4143 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4144 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4145 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4147 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4148 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4149 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4150 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4154 (setq org-todo-keywords
4155 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4158 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4159 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4162 @vindex org-log-done
4163 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4164 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4165 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4166 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4167 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4168 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4169 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4170 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4171 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4172 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4173 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4174 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4175 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4176 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4177 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4180 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4183 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4186 @cindex property, LOGGING
4187 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4188 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4189 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4190 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4191 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4192 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4195 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4197 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4199 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4201 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4203 * TODO No logging at all
4209 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4210 @subsection Tracking your habits
4213 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4214 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4218 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4221 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4223 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4225 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4226 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4227 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4228 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4230 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4231 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4232 three days, but at most every two days.
4234 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4235 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4236 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4237 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4240 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4241 actual habit with some history:
4245 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4246 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4247 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4248 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4249 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4250 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4251 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4252 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4253 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4254 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4255 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4258 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4262 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4263 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4264 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4265 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4266 after four days have elapsed.
4268 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4269 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4270 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4271 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4275 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4277 If the task could have been done on that day.
4279 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4281 If the task was overdue on that day.
4284 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4285 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4286 the current day falls in the graph.
4288 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4289 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4292 @item org-habit-graph-column
4293 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4294 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4295 titles brief and to the point.
4296 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4297 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4298 @item org-habit-following-days
4299 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4300 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4301 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4305 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4306 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4307 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4308 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4310 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4314 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4315 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4316 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4319 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4323 @vindex org-priority-faces
4324 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4325 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4326 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4327 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4328 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4329 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4331 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4337 @findex org-priority
4338 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4339 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4340 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4341 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4342 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4344 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4345 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4346 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4347 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4348 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4349 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4350 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4353 @vindex org-highest-priority
4354 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4355 @vindex org-default-priority
4356 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4357 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4358 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4359 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4360 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4363 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4368 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4369 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4370 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4371 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4373 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4374 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4375 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4376 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4377 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4378 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4379 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4380 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4381 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4384 * Organize Party [33%]
4385 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4389 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4392 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4393 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4394 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4395 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4398 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4399 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4400 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4401 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4402 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4406 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4408 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4412 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4413 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4416 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4417 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4418 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4419 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4421 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4425 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4426 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4429 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4433 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4434 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4435 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4436 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4437 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4438 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4439 in the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4440 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4441 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4442 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4444 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4447 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4448 - [-] call people [1/3]
4453 - [ ] think about what music to play
4454 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4457 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4458 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4459 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4462 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4463 @cindex checkbox statistics
4464 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4465 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4466 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4467 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4468 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4469 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4470 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4471 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4472 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4473 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4474 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4475 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4476 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4477 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4478 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4479 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4480 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4481 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4482 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4484 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4485 @cindex checkbox blocking
4486 @cindex property, ORDERED
4487 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4488 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4489 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4491 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4494 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4495 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4496 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4497 one@footnote{@kbd{C-u C-c C-c} on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4498 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4499 considered to be an intermediate state.
4500 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4501 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4502 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4506 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4507 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4508 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4510 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4511 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4513 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4515 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4516 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4517 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4518 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4519 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4520 @cindex property, ORDERED
4521 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4522 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4523 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4524 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4525 for better visibility, customize the variable
4526 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4527 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4528 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4529 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4530 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4531 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4532 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4533 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4536 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4539 @cindex headline tagging
4540 @cindex matching, tags
4541 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4543 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4544 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4547 @vindex org-tag-faces
4548 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4549 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4550 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4551 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4552 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4553 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4554 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4555 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4558 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4559 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4560 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4563 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4564 @section Tag inheritance
4565 @cindex tag inheritance
4566 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4567 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4569 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4570 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4571 well. For example, in the list
4574 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4575 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4576 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4580 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4581 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4582 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4583 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4584 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4585 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4586 changes in the line.}:
4590 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4594 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4595 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4596 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4597 To turn it off entirely, use @code{org-use-tag-inheritance}.
4599 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4600 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4601 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4602 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4603 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4604 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4605 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4606 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4608 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
4609 Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag,
4610 either in the @code{tags} or @code{tags-todo} agenda types. In other agenda
4611 types, @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} has no effect. Still, you may want to
4612 have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine,
4613 with inherited tags. Set @code{org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance} to control
4614 this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to nil
4615 can really speed up agenda generation.
4617 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4618 @section Setting tags
4619 @cindex setting tags
4620 @cindex tags, setting
4623 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4624 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4625 also a special command for inserting tags:
4628 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4629 @cindex completion, of tags
4630 @vindex org-tags-column
4631 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4632 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4633 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4634 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4635 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4636 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4637 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4638 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4639 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4642 @vindex org-tag-alist
4643 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4644 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4645 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4646 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4647 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4651 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4652 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4655 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4656 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4657 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4663 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4664 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4665 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4666 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4667 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4668 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4674 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4675 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4676 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4677 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4678 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4679 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4680 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4681 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4685 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4688 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4689 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4692 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4695 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4696 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4697 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4700 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4703 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4706 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4707 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4711 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4715 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4718 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4719 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4721 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4722 these lines to activate any changes.
4725 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4726 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4727 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4728 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4732 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4733 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4734 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4736 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4739 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4740 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4741 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4742 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4743 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4748 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4749 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4750 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4753 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4754 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4755 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4759 Clear all tags for this line.
4762 Accept the modified set.
4764 Abort without installing changes.
4766 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4768 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4769 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4771 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4772 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4777 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4778 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4779 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4780 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4781 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4782 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4783 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4784 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4786 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4787 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4788 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4789 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4790 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4791 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4792 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4793 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4794 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4795 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4796 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4798 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4799 @section Tag searches
4800 @cindex tag searches
4801 @cindex searching for tags
4803 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4804 information into special lists.
4807 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4808 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4809 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4810 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4811 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4812 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4813 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4814 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4815 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4816 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4817 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4820 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4821 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4822 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4823 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4824 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4825 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4826 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4829 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4830 @chapter Properties and columns
4833 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4834 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4835 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4837 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4838 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4839 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4840 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4841 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4842 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4843 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4844 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4845 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4847 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4848 (@pxref{Column view}).
4851 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4852 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4853 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4854 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4855 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4856 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4859 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4860 @section Property syntax
4861 @cindex property syntax
4862 @cindex drawer, for properties
4864 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4865 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4866 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4867 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4868 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4873 *** Goldberg Variations
4875 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4876 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4878 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4883 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4884 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4885 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4887 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4888 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4889 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4890 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4891 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4892 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4893 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4898 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4899 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4903 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4904 file, use a line like
4905 @cindex property, _ALL
4908 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4911 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4912 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4913 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4916 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4917 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4920 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4921 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4922 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4930 *** Goldberg Variations
4932 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4933 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4935 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4940 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4942 @vindex org-global-properties
4943 Property values set with the global variable
4944 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4948 The following commands help to work with properties:
4951 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4952 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4953 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4954 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4955 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4956 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4957 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4958 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4959 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4960 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4961 information like deadlines.
4962 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4963 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4964 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4965 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4966 can be inserted using completion.
4967 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4968 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4969 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4970 Remove a property from the current entry.
4971 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4972 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4973 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4974 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4975 nearest column format definition.
4978 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4979 @section Special properties
4980 @cindex properties, special
4982 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
4983 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4984 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4985 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4986 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4987 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4989 @cindex property, special, ID
4990 @cindex property, special, TODO
4991 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4992 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4993 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4994 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4995 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4996 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4997 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4998 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4999 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5000 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5001 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5002 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5003 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5004 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5005 @cindex property, special, FILE
5007 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5008 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5009 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5010 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5011 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5012 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5013 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5014 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5015 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5016 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5017 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5018 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5019 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5020 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5021 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5022 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5023 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5024 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5025 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5026 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5029 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5030 @section Property searches
5031 @cindex properties, searching
5032 @cindex searching, of properties
5034 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5035 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5037 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5038 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5039 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5040 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5041 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5042 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5043 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5044 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5045 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5046 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5047 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5050 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5053 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5058 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5059 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5060 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5061 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5062 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5065 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5066 @section Property Inheritance
5067 @cindex properties, inheritance
5068 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5070 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5071 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5072 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5073 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5074 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5075 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5076 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5077 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5078 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5079 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5080 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5081 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5082 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5084 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5085 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5087 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5090 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5091 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5092 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5093 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5094 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5096 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5097 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5098 applies to the entire subtree.
5100 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5101 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5102 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5104 @cindex property, LOGGING
5105 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5106 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5109 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5110 @section Column view
5112 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5113 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5114 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5115 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5116 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5117 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5118 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5119 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5120 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5121 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5122 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5123 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5124 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5127 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5128 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5129 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5132 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5133 @subsection Defining columns
5134 @cindex column view, for properties
5135 @cindex properties, column view
5137 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5138 done by defining a column format line.
5141 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5142 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5145 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5146 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5148 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5152 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5155 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5156 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5159 ** Top node for columns view
5161 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5165 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5166 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5167 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5168 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5169 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5170 deeper part of the tree.
5172 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5173 @subsubsection Column attributes
5174 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5175 definition looks like this:
5178 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5182 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5183 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5186 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5187 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5188 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5189 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5190 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5191 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5193 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5194 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5195 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5196 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5197 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5198 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5199 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5200 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5201 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5202 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5203 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5204 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5205 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5206 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5207 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5208 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5209 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5210 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5211 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5212 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5216 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5217 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5218 same summary information.
5220 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5221 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5222 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5223 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5224 1--10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5225 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5227 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5228 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5229 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5230 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5231 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5232 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5233 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5234 full job more realistically, at 10--15 days.
5236 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5240 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5241 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5242 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5243 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5244 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5248 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5249 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5250 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5251 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5252 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5253 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5254 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5255 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5256 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5257 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5258 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5259 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5260 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5261 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5264 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5265 @subsection Using column view
5268 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5269 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5270 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5271 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5272 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5273 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5274 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5275 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5276 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5277 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5278 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5279 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5280 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5281 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5282 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5284 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5286 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5287 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5288 Move through the column view from field to field.
5289 @kindex S-@key{left}
5290 @kindex S-@key{right}
5291 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5292 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5293 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5295 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5296 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5297 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5298 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5299 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5300 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5301 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5302 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5303 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5304 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5305 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5306 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5307 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5308 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5309 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5310 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5311 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5312 current column view.
5313 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5314 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5315 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5316 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5317 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5318 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5319 Delete the current column.
5322 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5323 @subsection Capturing column view
5325 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5326 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5327 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5328 of this block looks like this:
5330 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5333 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5338 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5342 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5343 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5344 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5345 capture, you can use 4 values:
5346 @cindex property, ID
5348 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5349 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5350 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5351 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5352 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5353 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5354 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5355 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5358 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5359 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5361 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5363 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5364 @item :skip-empty-rows
5365 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5366 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5371 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5374 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5375 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5376 for the scope or ID of the view.
5377 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5378 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5379 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5380 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5381 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5382 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5386 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5387 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5388 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5389 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5391 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5392 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5393 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5394 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5395 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5396 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5397 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5399 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5400 @section The Property API
5401 @cindex properties, API
5402 @cindex API, for properties
5404 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5405 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5406 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5409 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5410 @chapter Dates and times
5416 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5417 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5418 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5419 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5420 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5421 is used in a much wider sense.
5424 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5425 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5426 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5427 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5428 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5429 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5430 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5434 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5435 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5437 @cindex ranges, time
5442 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5443 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5444 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5445 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5446 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5447 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5448 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5449 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5450 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5451 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5454 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5457 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5458 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5459 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5460 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5463 * Meet Peter at the movies
5464 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5465 * Discussion on climate change
5466 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5469 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5470 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5471 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5472 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5473 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5474 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5477 * Pick up Sam at school
5478 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5481 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5482 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5483 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5484 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5485 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5486 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5487 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5488 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5489 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5490 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5491 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5492 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5493 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5494 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5495 example with optional time
5498 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5499 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5502 @item Time/Date range
5505 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5506 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5507 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5510 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5511 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5514 @item Inactive timestamp
5515 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5516 @cindex inactive timestamp
5517 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5518 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5519 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5522 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5528 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5529 @section Creating timestamps
5530 @cindex creating timestamps
5531 @cindex timestamps, creating
5533 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5534 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5538 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5539 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5540 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5541 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5542 succession, a time range is inserted.
5544 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5545 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5552 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5553 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5554 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5555 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5558 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5560 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5561 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5563 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5564 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5565 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5568 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5569 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5570 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5572 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5573 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5574 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5576 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5577 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5578 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5579 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5580 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5581 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5582 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5583 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5584 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5586 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5587 @cindex evaluate time range
5588 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5589 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5590 the following column).
5595 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5596 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5599 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5600 @subsection The date/time prompt
5601 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5602 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5604 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5605 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5606 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5607 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5608 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5609 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5610 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5611 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5612 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5613 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5614 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5615 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5616 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5617 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5618 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5619 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5620 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5621 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5623 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5624 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5628 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5629 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5630 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5631 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5632 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5633 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5634 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5635 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5636 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5637 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5638 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5639 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5640 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5641 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5644 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5645 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5646 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5647 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5648 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5649 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5650 the Nth such day, e.g.:
5655 +4d @result{} four days from today
5656 +4 @result{} same as above
5657 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5658 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5659 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5662 @vindex parse-time-months
5663 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5664 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5665 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5666 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5668 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5669 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5670 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5671 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5672 read the docstring of the variable
5673 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5675 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5676 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5677 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5681 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5682 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5683 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5686 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5687 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5688 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5689 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5690 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5691 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5692 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5693 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5694 from the minibuffer:
5701 @kindex S-@key{right}
5702 @kindex S-@key{left}
5703 @kindex S-@key{down}
5705 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5706 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5709 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5710 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5711 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5712 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5713 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5714 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5715 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5718 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5719 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5720 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5721 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5722 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5723 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5724 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5726 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5727 @subsection Custom time format
5728 @cindex custom date/time format
5729 @cindex time format, custom
5730 @cindex date format, custom
5732 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5733 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5734 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5735 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5736 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5737 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5738 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5741 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5742 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5746 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5747 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5748 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5749 following consequences:
5752 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5755 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5756 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5757 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5758 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5759 time will be changed by one minute.
5761 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5762 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5764 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5765 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5766 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5768 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5769 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5770 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5774 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5775 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5777 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5781 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5783 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5784 to be finished on that date.
5786 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5787 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5788 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5789 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5790 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5791 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
5794 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5795 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5796 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5799 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5800 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5801 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5804 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5806 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5809 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5810 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5811 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
5812 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5813 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5814 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
5815 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5818 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5819 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5823 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5824 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5825 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5826 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5827 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5828 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5829 want to start working on an action item.
5832 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5833 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5834 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5835 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5837 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5839 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5840 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5841 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5845 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5846 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5849 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5850 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5852 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5853 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5854 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5859 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5860 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5861 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5862 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5863 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5864 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5865 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5868 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5869 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5870 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5871 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5872 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5873 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5874 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5875 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5878 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5881 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5882 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5883 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5884 schedule the marked item.
5886 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5887 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5888 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5889 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5890 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5891 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5892 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5893 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5895 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5896 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5898 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5899 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5902 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5903 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
5904 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5905 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5907 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5908 @subsection Repeated tasks
5909 @cindex tasks, repeated
5910 @cindex repeated tasks
5912 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5913 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5914 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5916 ** TODO Pay the rent
5917 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5920 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5921 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5922 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5923 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5924 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5925 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5927 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5928 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5929 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5930 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5931 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5932 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5933 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5934 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5935 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5936 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5937 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5938 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5939 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5940 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5941 switch the date like this:
5944 ** TODO Pay the rent
5945 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5948 @vindex org-log-repeat
5949 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5950 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5951 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5952 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5953 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5955 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5956 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5959 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5960 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5961 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5962 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5963 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5964 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5965 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5966 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5967 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5971 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5972 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5973 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5974 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5975 and marked it done on Saturday.
5976 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5977 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5978 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5982 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5983 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5985 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5986 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5987 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5990 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5991 @section Clocking work time
5992 @cindex clocking time
5993 @cindex time clocking
5995 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5996 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
5997 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
5998 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
5999 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6000 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6001 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6002 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6003 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6005 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6007 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6008 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6010 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6011 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6012 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6013 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6017 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6018 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6019 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6022 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6023 @subsection Clocking commands
6026 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6027 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6028 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6029 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6030 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6031 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6032 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6033 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6034 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6035 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6036 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6037 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6038 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6039 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6040 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6041 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6042 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6043 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6044 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6045 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6046 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6047 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6048 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6049 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6050 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6051 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6052 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6053 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6054 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6055 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6056 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6057 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6058 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6059 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6060 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6061 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6063 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6064 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6065 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6066 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6067 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6068 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6069 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6070 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6071 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6072 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6073 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6074 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6075 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6076 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6078 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6079 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6082 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6083 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6084 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6085 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6086 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6087 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6088 clock duration keeps the same.
6089 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6090 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6091 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6092 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6093 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6094 increased by five minutes.
6095 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6096 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6097 if it is running in this same item.
6098 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6099 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6100 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6101 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6102 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6103 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6104 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6105 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6106 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6107 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6108 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6109 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6110 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6114 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6115 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6116 worked on or closed during a day.
6118 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6119 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6120 modify the window disposition.
6122 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6123 @subsection The clock table
6124 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6125 @cindex report, of clocked time
6127 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6128 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6129 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6132 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6133 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6134 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6135 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6136 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6137 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6138 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6139 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6140 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6141 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6142 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6143 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6144 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6145 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6146 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6147 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6148 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6152 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6153 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6155 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6157 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6161 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6162 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6163 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6164 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6166 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6169 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6170 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6171 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6172 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6173 file @r{the full current buffer}
6174 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6175 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6176 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6177 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6178 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6179 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6180 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6181 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6182 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6184 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6185 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6186 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6187 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6188 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6189 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6190 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6191 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6192 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6193 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6194 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6195 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6196 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6197 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6198 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6199 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6200 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6201 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6204 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6205 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6206 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6208 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6209 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6210 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6211 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6212 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6213 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6214 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6215 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6216 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6217 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6218 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6219 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6220 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6221 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6222 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6223 @r{property will get its own column.}
6224 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6225 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6226 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6227 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6228 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6229 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6231 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6232 day, you could write
6234 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6238 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6239 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6240 only to fit it into the manual.}
6242 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6243 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6246 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6248 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6251 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6254 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6258 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6259 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6261 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6262 @cindex resolve idle time
6264 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6265 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6266 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6267 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6268 applying it to another one.
6270 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6271 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6272 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6273 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6274 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6275 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6276 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6277 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6278 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6279 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6280 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6281 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6285 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6286 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6287 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6289 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6290 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6291 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6293 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6294 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6296 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6297 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6298 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6300 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6301 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6302 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6303 log with an empty entry.
6306 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6307 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6308 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6309 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6310 the next task you clock in on.
6312 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6313 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6314 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6315 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6316 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6318 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6319 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6320 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6321 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6322 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6323 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6325 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6326 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6328 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6329 @cindex continuous clocking
6330 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6332 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6333 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6334 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6335 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6337 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6338 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6340 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6341 @section Effort estimates
6342 @cindex effort estimates
6344 @cindex property, Effort
6345 @vindex org-effort-property
6346 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6347 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6348 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6349 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6350 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6351 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6352 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6353 for an entry with the following commands:
6356 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6357 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6358 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6359 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6360 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6361 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6364 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6365 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6366 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6367 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6371 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6372 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6376 @vindex org-global-properties
6377 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6378 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6379 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6380 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6381 setup may be advised.
6383 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6384 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6385 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6386 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6388 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6389 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6390 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6391 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6392 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6393 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6394 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6395 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6396 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6398 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6399 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6400 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6401 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6403 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6404 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6405 @cindex relative timer
6407 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6408 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6409 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6412 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6413 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6414 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6416 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6417 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6418 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6419 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6420 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6422 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6425 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6426 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6427 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6428 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6430 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6431 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6432 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6433 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6434 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6435 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6436 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6437 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6438 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6439 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6440 not started at exactly the right moment.
6443 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6444 @section Countdown timer
6445 @cindex Countdown timer
6449 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6450 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6452 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6453 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6454 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6457 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6458 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6461 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6462 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6463 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6464 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6465 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6466 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6469 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6470 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6471 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6472 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6473 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6474 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6477 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6481 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6482 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6483 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6484 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6485 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6487 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6488 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6490 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6492 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6493 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6494 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6495 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6497 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6498 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6499 does enhance it with templates and more.
6502 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6503 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6504 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6507 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6508 @subsection Setting up capture
6510 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6511 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6512 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6514 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6516 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6517 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6520 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6521 @subsection Using capture
6524 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6525 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6526 not active by default: you need to install it. If you have templates
6528 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6529 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6530 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6531 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6533 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6534 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6535 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6536 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6537 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6539 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6540 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6541 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6542 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6543 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6544 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6545 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6547 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6548 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6552 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6553 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6554 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6555 rather than to the current date.
6557 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6562 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6563 template in the usual way.
6564 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6565 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6568 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6569 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6570 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6571 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6574 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6575 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6577 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6578 @subsection Capture templates
6579 @cindex templates, for Capture
6581 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6582 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6583 through the customize interface.
6587 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6590 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6591 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6592 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6593 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6594 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6598 (setq org-capture-templates
6599 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6600 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6601 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6602 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6605 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6609 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6613 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6614 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6615 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6616 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6617 place where you started the capture process.
6619 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6620 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6624 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6625 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6629 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6630 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6631 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6634 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6635 @subsubsection Template elements
6637 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6638 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6642 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6643 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6644 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6645 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6646 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6647 prefix key, for example
6649 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6651 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6652 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6655 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6659 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6662 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6663 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6665 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6666 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6668 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6671 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6672 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6673 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6675 Text to be inserted as it is.
6679 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6680 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6681 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6682 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6683 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6684 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6685 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6689 @item (file "path/to/file")
6690 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6692 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6693 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6695 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6696 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6698 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6699 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6701 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6702 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6704 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6705 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6707 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6708 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6710 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6711 A function to find the right location in the file.
6714 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6716 @item (function function-finding-location)
6717 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6722 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6723 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6724 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6725 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6726 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6730 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6731 Recognized properties are:
6734 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6735 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6736 Setting this property will change that.
6738 @item :immediate-finish
6739 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6740 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6741 information that can be added automatically.
6744 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6745 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6748 Start the clock in this item.
6751 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6754 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6755 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6756 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6757 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6760 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6761 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6763 @item :table-line-pos
6764 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6765 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6766 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6770 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6771 buffer again after capture is completed.
6775 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6776 @subsubsection Template expansion
6778 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6779 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6780 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6783 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6784 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6785 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6786 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6787 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6788 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6789 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6790 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6791 @r{region is active.}
6792 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6793 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6794 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6795 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6796 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6797 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6798 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6799 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6800 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6801 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6802 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6803 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6804 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6805 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6806 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6807 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6808 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6809 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6810 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6811 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6812 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6813 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6814 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6815 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6816 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6817 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6821 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6822 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6823 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6824 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6827 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6829 Link type | Available keywords
6830 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6831 bbdb | %:name %:company
6832 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6833 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6834 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6835 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6836 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6837 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6838 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6839 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6840 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6842 info | %:file %:node
6847 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6850 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6853 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6854 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6856 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6857 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6858 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6859 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6860 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6863 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6864 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6867 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6868 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6871 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6872 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6875 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6877 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6878 @section Attachments
6881 @vindex org-attach-directory
6882 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6883 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6884 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6885 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6886 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6887 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6888 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6889 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6890 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6891 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6892 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6893 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6894 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6896 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6897 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6898 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6901 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6905 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6906 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6907 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6908 to select a command:
6911 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6912 @vindex org-attach-method
6913 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6914 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6915 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6921 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6922 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6924 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6925 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6927 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6928 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6929 attachments yourself.
6931 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6932 @vindex org-file-apps
6933 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6934 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6935 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6936 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6938 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6939 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6941 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6942 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6944 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6945 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6947 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6948 Select and delete a single attachment.
6950 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6951 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6952 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6954 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6955 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6956 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6957 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6959 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6960 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6961 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6962 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6966 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6971 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6972 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6973 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6974 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6975 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6976 information. Here is just an example:
6979 (setq org-feed-alist
6981 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6982 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6986 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6987 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6988 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6989 the following command is used:
6992 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6994 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6996 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6997 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7000 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7001 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7002 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7003 list of drawers in that file:
7006 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7009 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7010 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7012 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7013 @section Protocols for external access
7014 @cindex protocols, for external access
7017 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7018 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7019 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7020 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7021 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7022 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7023 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7024 documentation and setup instructions.
7026 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7027 @section Refiling notes
7028 @cindex refiling notes
7030 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7031 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7032 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7033 process, you can use the following special command:
7036 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7037 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7038 @vindex org-refile-targets
7039 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7040 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7041 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7042 @vindex org-log-refile
7043 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7044 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7045 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7046 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7047 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7049 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7050 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7051 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7052 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7053 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7054 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7055 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7056 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7057 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7058 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7059 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7060 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7061 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7062 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7063 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7064 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7066 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7067 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7068 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7069 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7070 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7073 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7077 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7078 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7079 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7080 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7083 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7084 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7085 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7086 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7090 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7091 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7094 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7095 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7096 @cindex external archiving
7098 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7102 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7103 @vindex org-archive-location
7104 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7105 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7106 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7107 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7108 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7109 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7110 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7111 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7114 @cindex archive locations
7115 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7116 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7117 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7118 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7119 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7120 see the documentation string of the variable
7121 @code{org-archive-location}.
7123 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7124 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7125 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7126 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7127 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7128 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7129 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7130 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7134 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7137 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7139 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7140 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7141 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7143 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7144 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7145 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7146 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7147 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7151 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7152 @subsection Internal archiving
7154 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7155 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7157 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7158 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7161 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7162 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7163 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7164 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7165 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7166 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7168 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7169 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7170 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7171 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7173 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7174 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7175 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7176 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7177 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7178 temporarily included.
7180 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7181 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7182 is. Configure the details using the variable
7183 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7185 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7186 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7187 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7190 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7193 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7194 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7195 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7197 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7198 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7199 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7200 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7201 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7202 level 1 trees will be checked.
7203 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7204 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7205 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7206 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7207 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7208 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7209 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7214 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7215 @chapter Agenda views
7216 @cindex agenda views
7218 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7219 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7220 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7221 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7222 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7224 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7225 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7229 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7232 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7235 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7236 TODO state associated with them,
7238 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7239 in time-sorted view,
7241 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7242 that contain specified keywords,
7244 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7247 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7252 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7253 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7254 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7255 edit these files remotely.
7257 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7258 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7259 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7260 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7261 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7262 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7265 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7266 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7267 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7268 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7269 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7270 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7271 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7272 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7275 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7276 @section Agenda files
7277 @cindex agenda files
7278 @cindex files for agenda
7280 @vindex org-agenda-files
7281 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7282 files}, the files listed in the variable
7283 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7284 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7285 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7286 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7289 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7290 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7291 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7292 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7293 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7294 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7296 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7298 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7299 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7300 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7301 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7302 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7303 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7305 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7306 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7308 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7309 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7310 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7311 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7316 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7317 to visit any of them.
7319 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7320 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7321 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7322 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7323 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7324 extended period, use the following commands:
7327 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7328 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7329 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7330 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7331 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7332 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7333 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7334 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7335 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7339 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7342 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7343 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7344 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7345 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7347 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7348 Lift the restriction.
7351 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7352 @section The agenda dispatcher
7353 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7354 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7355 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7356 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7357 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7358 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7359 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7360 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7363 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7365 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7367 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7368 tags and properties}).
7370 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7372 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7373 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7375 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7376 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7377 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7378 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7379 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7382 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7384 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7385 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7386 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7387 selecting the command.
7389 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7390 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7391 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7392 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7393 character selecting the command.
7396 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7397 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7398 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7399 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7400 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7401 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7402 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7403 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7404 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7407 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7408 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7409 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7410 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7411 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7413 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7414 @section The built-in agenda views
7416 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7419 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7420 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7421 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7422 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7423 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7424 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7427 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7428 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7430 @cindex weekly agenda
7431 @cindex daily agenda
7433 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7434 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7437 @cindex org-agenda, command
7438 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7439 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7440 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7441 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7442 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7443 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7444 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7447 @vindex org-agenda-span
7448 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7449 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7450 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7451 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7452 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7455 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7456 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7457 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7460 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7461 @cindex calendar integration
7462 @cindex diary integration
7464 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7465 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7466 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7467 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7468 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7469 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7472 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7473 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7476 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7479 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7480 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7481 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7482 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7483 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7484 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7485 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7486 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7487 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7488 between calendar and agenda.
7490 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7491 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7492 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7493 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7494 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7495 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7496 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7497 will be made in the agenda:
7500 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7502 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7504 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7505 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7508 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7509 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7510 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7512 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7513 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7514 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7515 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7516 following to one of your agenda files:
7523 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7526 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7527 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7528 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7529 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7530 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7531 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7532 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7538 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7541 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7542 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7543 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7544 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7545 in an Org or Diary file.
7547 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7548 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7549 @cindex appointment reminders
7553 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7554 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7555 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7556 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7557 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7558 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7559 docstring for details.
7561 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7562 @subsection The global TODO list
7563 @cindex global TODO list
7564 @cindex TODO list, global
7566 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7567 collected into a single place.
7570 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7571 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7572 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7573 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7574 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7575 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7576 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7577 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7578 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7579 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7580 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7581 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7582 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7583 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7585 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7586 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7587 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7588 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7589 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7590 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7593 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7594 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7595 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7597 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7598 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7599 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7603 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7604 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7605 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7606 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7607 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7608 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7609 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7610 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7611 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7612 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7615 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7616 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7617 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7618 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7619 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7622 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7623 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7624 @cindex matching, of tags
7625 @cindex matching, of properties
7629 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7630 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7631 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7632 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7636 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7637 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7638 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7639 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7640 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7641 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7642 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7643 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7644 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7645 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7646 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7647 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7648 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7649 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7653 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7656 @subsubheading Match syntax
7658 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7659 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7660 OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7661 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7662 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7663 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7664 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7665 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7666 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7670 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7673 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7674 @item work|laptop+night
7675 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7679 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7680 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7681 braces. For example,
7682 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7683 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7685 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7686 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7687 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7688 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7689 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7690 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7691 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7692 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7693 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7694 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7695 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7696 DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7697 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7698 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7699 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7700 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7702 Here are more examples:
7704 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7705 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7706 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7707 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7708 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7711 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7712 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7715 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7716 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7720 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7723 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7724 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7725 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7727 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7728 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7730 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7731 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7732 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7733 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7734 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7735 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
7736 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7737 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7738 respectively, can be used.
7740 If the comparison value is enclosed
7741 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7742 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7746 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7747 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7748 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7749 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7750 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7751 on or after October 11, 2008.
7753 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7754 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7755 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7758 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7759 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7760 inheritance}, for details.
7762 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7763 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7764 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7765 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7766 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7767 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7768 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
7769 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7770 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7771 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7772 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7773 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7777 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7778 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7779 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7781 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7782 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7786 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7787 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7788 @cindex timeline, single file
7789 @cindex time-sorted view
7791 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7792 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7793 to give an overview over events in a project.
7796 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7797 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7798 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7799 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7803 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7804 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7806 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7807 @subsection Search view
7810 @cindex searching, for text
7812 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7813 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7816 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7817 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7818 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7820 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7821 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7822 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7823 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7824 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7825 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7826 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7827 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7828 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7829 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7830 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7832 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7833 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7834 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7836 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7837 @subsection Stuck projects
7838 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7840 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7841 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7842 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7843 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7844 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7845 projects and define next actions for them.
7848 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7849 List projects that are stuck.
7852 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7853 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7854 project is and how to find it.
7857 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7858 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7859 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7860 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7862 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7863 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7864 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7865 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7866 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7867 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7868 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7869 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7870 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7871 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7872 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7873 correct customization for this is
7876 (setq org-stuck-projects
7877 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7881 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7882 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7884 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7885 @section Presentation and sorting
7886 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7888 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7889 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7890 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7891 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7892 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7893 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7894 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7895 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7896 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7897 associated with the item.
7900 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7901 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7902 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7905 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7906 @subsection Categories
7910 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7911 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7912 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7913 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7914 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7915 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7916 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7917 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7918 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7926 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7927 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7928 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7929 special category you want to apply as the value.
7932 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7933 longer than 10 characters.
7936 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7937 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7939 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7940 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7941 @cindex time-of-day specification
7943 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7944 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7945 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7946 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7948 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7950 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7951 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7952 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7953 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7955 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7956 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7957 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7960 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7961 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7962 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7963 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7967 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7968 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7971 8:00...... ------------------
7972 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7973 10:00...... ------------------
7974 12:00...... ------------------
7975 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7976 14:00...... ------------------
7977 16:00...... ------------------
7978 18:00...... ------------------
7979 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7980 20:00...... ------------------
7981 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7984 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7985 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7986 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7987 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7988 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7990 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7991 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7992 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7993 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7994 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7995 done depends on the type of view.
7998 @vindex org-agenda-files
7999 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8000 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8001 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8002 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8003 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8004 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8005 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8006 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8007 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8009 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8010 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8011 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8012 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8015 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8016 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8019 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8020 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8021 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8022 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8024 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8025 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8026 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8028 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8029 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8030 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8031 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8032 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8033 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8035 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8036 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8039 @tsubheading{Motion}
8040 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8041 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8042 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8043 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8044 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8045 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8046 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8047 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8048 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8049 outline, not only the heading.
8051 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8052 Display original location and recenter that window.
8054 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8055 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8057 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8058 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8060 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8061 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8062 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8063 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8064 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8065 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8066 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8068 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8069 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8070 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8071 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8072 previously used indirect buffer.
8074 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8075 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8076 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8077 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8079 @tsubheading{Change display}
8080 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8083 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8087 Delete other windows.
8089 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8090 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8091 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8092 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8093 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8094 @vindex org-agenda-span
8095 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8096 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8097 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8098 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8099 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8100 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8101 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8102 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8103 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8104 1938--2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8105 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8107 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8108 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8109 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8110 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8112 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8113 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8115 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8118 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8119 Prompt for a date and go there.
8121 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8122 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8124 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8125 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8127 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8129 @vindex org-log-done
8130 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8131 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8132 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8133 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8134 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8135 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8136 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8137 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8138 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8140 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8141 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8142 agenda and timeline views.
8144 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8145 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8146 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8147 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8148 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8149 press @kbd{v a} again.
8151 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8152 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8153 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8154 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8155 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8156 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8157 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8158 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8159 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8160 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8161 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8162 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8165 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8166 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8167 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8168 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8169 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8170 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8173 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8174 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8175 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8176 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8177 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8178 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8179 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8180 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8182 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8183 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8184 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8185 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8186 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8188 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8189 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8190 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8191 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8192 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8194 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8197 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8198 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8201 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8202 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8203 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8204 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8205 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8206 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8207 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8208 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8210 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8211 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8212 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8214 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8215 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8216 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8217 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8218 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8219 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8221 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8222 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8224 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8225 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8226 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8229 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8230 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8231 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8232 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8233 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8234 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8235 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8236 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8237 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8238 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8239 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8241 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8242 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8243 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8244 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8245 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8246 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8247 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8248 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8249 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8250 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8252 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8253 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8254 efforts globally, for example
8256 (setq org-global-properties
8257 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8259 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8260 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8261 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8262 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8263 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0--9 are not used
8264 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8265 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8266 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8267 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8268 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8270 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8271 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8272 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8273 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8274 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8275 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8276 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8277 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8278 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8282 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8284 ((string= tag "Net")
8285 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8286 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8287 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8288 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8289 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8292 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8296 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8297 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8298 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8299 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8300 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8309 @item @r{in} search view
8310 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8311 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8312 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8313 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8314 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8318 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8319 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8324 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8325 @cindex remote editing, undo
8326 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8327 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8328 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8330 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8331 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8334 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8335 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8336 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8338 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8339 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8340 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8341 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8342 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8343 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8345 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8346 Refile the entry at point.
8348 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8349 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8350 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8351 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8352 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8354 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8355 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8357 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8358 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8361 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8362 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8363 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8366 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8367 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8368 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8369 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8370 tags of a headline occasionally.
8372 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8373 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8374 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8378 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8379 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8380 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8382 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8383 Display weighted priority of current item.
8385 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8386 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8387 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8390 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8391 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8393 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8394 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8395 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8396 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8397 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8399 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8400 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8402 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8403 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8405 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8406 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8408 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8409 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8410 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8412 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8413 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8414 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8415 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8416 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8417 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8418 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8420 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8421 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8424 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8425 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8426 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8428 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8429 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8432 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8433 Stop the previously started clock.
8435 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8436 Cancel the currently running clock.
8438 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8439 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8441 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8442 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8443 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8444 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8445 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8446 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8448 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8449 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8450 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8451 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8453 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8454 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8457 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8458 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8460 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8461 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8463 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8464 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8466 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8467 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8468 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8469 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8470 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8471 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8472 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8475 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8476 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8477 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8478 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8479 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8480 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8481 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8482 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8483 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8484 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8485 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8486 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8487 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8488 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8489 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8490 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8491 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8492 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8494 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8495 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8496 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8497 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8498 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8499 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8500 @r{ (save-excursion}
8501 @r{ (save-restriction}
8503 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8504 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8505 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8509 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8510 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8512 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8513 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8515 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8516 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8519 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8520 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8521 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8522 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8523 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8524 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8525 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8526 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8527 you can add the entry.
8529 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8530 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8531 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8532 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8533 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8534 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8535 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8536 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8537 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8538 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8540 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8541 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8543 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8544 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8545 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8547 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8548 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8551 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8552 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8554 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8555 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8556 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8558 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8559 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8560 @cindex exporting agenda views
8561 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8562 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8563 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8564 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8565 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8566 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8567 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8568 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8569 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8571 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8572 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8573 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8575 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8576 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8577 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8578 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8579 visit Org files will not be removed.
8583 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8584 @section Custom agenda views
8585 @cindex custom agenda views
8586 @cindex agenda views, custom
8588 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8589 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8590 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8591 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8594 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8595 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8596 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8599 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8600 @subsection Storing searches
8602 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8603 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8604 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8607 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8608 @cindex agenda views, main example
8609 @cindex tags, as an agenda view
8610 @cindex todo, as an agenda view
8616 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8617 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8618 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8619 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8624 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8625 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8626 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8627 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8628 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8629 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8630 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8631 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8632 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8633 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8634 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8639 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8640 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8641 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8642 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8643 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8644 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8645 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8646 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8647 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8652 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8655 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8656 results as a sparse tree
8658 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8661 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8662 headlines that are also TODO items
8664 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8665 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8667 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8668 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8670 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8671 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8672 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8675 Note that the @code{*-tree} agenda views need to be called from an
8676 Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only.
8678 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8679 @subsection Block agenda
8680 @cindex block agenda
8681 @cindex agenda, with block views
8683 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8684 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8685 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8686 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8687 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8688 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8689 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8693 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8694 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8698 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8706 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8707 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8708 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8709 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8710 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8712 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8713 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8714 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8716 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8717 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8718 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8719 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8720 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8721 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8722 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8726 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8727 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8728 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8729 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8730 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8731 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8732 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8734 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8735 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8740 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8741 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8742 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8743 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8744 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8745 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8746 to only a single file.
8748 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8749 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8750 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8751 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8752 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8753 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8754 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8755 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8756 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8757 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8758 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8762 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8763 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8767 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8768 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8769 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8776 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8777 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8778 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8779 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8780 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8783 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8784 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8785 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8786 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8787 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8791 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8792 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8795 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8796 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8799 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8800 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8803 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8805 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8806 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8807 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8809 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8810 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8811 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8812 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8813 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8814 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8815 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8818 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8819 @cindex exporting agenda views
8820 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8821 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8822 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8823 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8824 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8825 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8826 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8827 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8829 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8830 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8831 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8832 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8834 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8835 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8836 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8837 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8838 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8842 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8843 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8844 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8845 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8846 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8847 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8848 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8849 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8850 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8855 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8856 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8857 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8858 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8863 ("~/views/home.html"))
8864 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8869 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8873 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8874 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8875 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8876 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8877 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8878 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8879 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8880 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8882 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8883 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8884 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8888 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8889 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8893 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8894 set options for the export commands. For example:
8897 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8899 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8900 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8901 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8902 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8903 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8908 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8909 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8910 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8911 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8912 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8913 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8914 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8915 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8916 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8919 From the command line you may also use
8921 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8924 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8925 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8927 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8928 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8929 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8930 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8931 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8935 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8936 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8939 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8940 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8944 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8945 @section Using column view in the agenda
8946 @cindex column view, in agenda
8947 @cindex agenda, column view
8949 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8950 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8951 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8952 collected by certain criteria.
8955 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8956 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8959 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8960 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8961 This causes the following issues:
8965 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8966 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8967 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8968 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8969 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8970 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8971 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8972 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8973 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8974 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8976 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8977 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8978 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8979 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8980 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8981 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8982 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8983 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8984 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8985 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8986 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8987 some values will count double.
8989 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8990 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8991 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8992 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8993 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8994 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8995 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8999 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9000 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9001 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9002 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9003 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9004 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9008 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9009 @chapter Markup for rich export
9011 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9012 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9013 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9014 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9015 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9018 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9019 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9020 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9021 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9022 * Index entries:: Making an index
9023 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9024 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9027 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9028 @section Structural markup elements
9031 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9032 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9033 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9034 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9036 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9037 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9038 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9039 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9040 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9043 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9044 @subheading Document title
9045 @cindex document title, markup rules
9048 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9052 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9056 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9057 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9058 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9059 title will be the file name without extension.
9061 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9062 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9063 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9064 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9066 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9067 @subheading Headings and sections
9068 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9070 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9071 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9072 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9073 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9074 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9075 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9076 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9077 per-file basis with a line
9084 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9085 @subheading Table of contents
9086 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9088 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9089 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9090 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9091 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9092 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9093 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9094 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9095 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9098 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9099 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9102 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9103 @subheading Text before the first headline
9104 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9107 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9108 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9109 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9110 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9112 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9113 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9114 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9115 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9116 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9117 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9120 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9121 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9125 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9126 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9127 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9130 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9132 @cindex lists, markup rules
9134 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9135 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9138 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9139 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9140 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9142 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9143 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9145 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9146 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9148 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9151 Great clouds overhead
9152 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9159 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9160 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9161 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9163 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9166 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9167 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9171 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9172 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9175 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9181 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9182 @subheading Footnote markup
9183 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9184 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9186 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9187 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9188 multiple footnotes side by side.
9190 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9191 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9193 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9194 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9195 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9196 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9197 @cindex code text, markup rules
9198 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9199 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9200 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9201 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9202 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9204 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9205 @subheading Horizontal rules
9206 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9207 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9208 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9210 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9211 @subheading Comment lines
9212 @cindex comment lines
9213 @cindex exporting, not
9214 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9216 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
9217 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and will never be exported.
9218 Also entire subtrees starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be
9219 exported. Finally, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
9220 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9225 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9229 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9230 @section Images and Tables
9232 @cindex tables, markup rules
9235 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9236 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9237 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9238 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9239 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9240 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9243 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9244 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9249 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9251 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9254 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9255 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9256 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9257 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9258 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9259 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9260 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9263 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9264 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9268 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9269 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9272 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9274 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9275 @section Literal examples
9276 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9277 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9279 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9280 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9281 for source code and similar examples.
9282 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9286 Some example from a text file.
9290 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9291 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9292 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9293 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9294 whitespace before the colon:
9298 : Some example from a text file.
9301 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9302 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9303 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9304 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9305 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9306 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9307 achieved using either the listings or the
9308 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9309 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9310 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9311 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9312 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9313 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9314 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9319 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9320 (defun org-xor (a b)
9326 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9327 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9328 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9329 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9330 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9331 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9332 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9333 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9336 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9337 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9338 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9339 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9340 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9341 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9345 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9346 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9347 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9349 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9353 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9354 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9355 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9356 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9358 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9359 areas in HTML export}).
9361 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9362 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9363 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9368 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9369 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9370 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9371 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9372 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9373 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9374 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9375 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9376 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9377 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9378 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9379 will create a new fixed-width region.
9382 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9383 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9384 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9385 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9386 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9390 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9391 @section Include files
9392 @cindex include files, markup rules
9394 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9395 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9399 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9402 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9403 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9404 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9405 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9406 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9407 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9408 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9409 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9410 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9414 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9417 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9418 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9419 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9423 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9424 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9425 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9431 Visit the include file at point.
9434 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9435 @section Index entries
9436 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9438 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9439 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9440 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9441 an index} for more information.
9446 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9452 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9453 @section Macro replacement
9454 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9457 You can define text snippets with
9460 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9463 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9464 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9465 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9466 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9467 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9468 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9469 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9470 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9471 @code{format-time-string}.
9473 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9474 construct complex HTML code.
9477 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9478 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9479 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9480 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9482 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9483 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9484 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9485 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9486 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9487 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9488 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9489 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9490 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9493 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9494 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9495 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9496 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9497 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9500 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9501 @subsection Special symbols
9502 @cindex math symbols
9503 @cindex special symbols
9504 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9505 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9506 @cindex HTML entities
9507 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9509 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9510 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9511 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9512 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9513 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9514 delimiters, for example:
9517 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9520 @vindex org-entities
9521 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9522 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9523 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9524 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9525 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9526 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9528 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9529 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9530 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9531 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9532 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9534 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9535 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9536 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9537 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9542 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9543 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9544 for display purposes only.
9547 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9548 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9552 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9553 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9554 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9555 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9556 with curly braces. For example
9559 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9560 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9563 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9564 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9565 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9566 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9567 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9568 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9569 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9575 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9576 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9581 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9582 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9585 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9586 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9587 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9589 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9590 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9591 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9592 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9593 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9594 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9595 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9596 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9597 @file{MathJax} on your own
9598 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9599 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9600 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9601 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9602 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9603 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9604 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9605 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9608 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9609 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9612 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9613 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9614 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9615 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9616 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9618 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9619 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9620 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9621 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9622 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9623 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9624 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9627 @noindent For example:
9630 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9631 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9632 \end@{equation@} % etc
9634 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9635 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9639 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9640 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9641 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9642 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9644 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9645 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9646 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9647 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9648 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9652 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9653 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9654 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9655 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9658 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9659 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9660 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9662 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9663 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9668 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9669 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9670 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9671 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9672 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9673 process the entire buffer.
9676 Remove the overlay preview images.
9679 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9680 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9681 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9682 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9685 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9686 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9689 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9690 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9691 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9692 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9693 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9694 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9695 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9696 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9697 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9701 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9704 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9705 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9709 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9712 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9713 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9714 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9715 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9716 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9717 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9718 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9719 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9720 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9721 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9722 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9726 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9727 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9728 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9729 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9730 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9731 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9734 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9735 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9736 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9739 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9740 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9741 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9742 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9746 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9750 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9751 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9752 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9753 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9754 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9755 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9756 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9757 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9758 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9759 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9760 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9761 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9762 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9763 these different formats.
9765 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9766 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9769 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9770 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9771 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9772 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9773 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9774 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9775 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9776 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9777 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9778 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9779 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9780 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9783 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9784 @section Selective export
9785 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9787 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9788 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9789 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9790 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9791 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9792 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9793 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9797 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9798 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9799 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9800 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9803 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9807 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9808 be removed from the export buffer.
9811 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9812 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9813 variable for more information.
9815 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9816 @section Export options
9817 @cindex options, for export
9819 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9820 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9821 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9822 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9823 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9824 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9825 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9826 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9827 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9828 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9831 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9832 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9839 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9847 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9848 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9850 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9851 @vindex user-full-name
9852 @vindex user-mail-address
9853 @vindex org-export-default-language
9854 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9856 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9857 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9858 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9859 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9860 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9861 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9862 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g., @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9863 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9864 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9865 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9866 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g., @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9867 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9868 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9869 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9870 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9871 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9872 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9873 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9877 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9878 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9879 settings. Here you can:
9880 @cindex headline levels
9881 @cindex section-numbers
9882 @cindex table of contents
9883 @cindex line-break preservation
9884 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9885 @cindex fixed-width sections
9887 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9889 @cindex special strings
9890 @cindex emphasized text
9891 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9892 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9893 @cindex author info, in export
9894 @cindex time info, in export
9895 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9896 @vindex org-export-author-info
9897 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9898 @vindex org-export-email-info
9899 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9901 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9902 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9903 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9904 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9905 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9906 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9907 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9908 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9909 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9910 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9911 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9912 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9913 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9914 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9915 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9916 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9917 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9918 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9919 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9920 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9921 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9922 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9923 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9924 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9925 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9926 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9927 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9930 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9931 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9932 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9934 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9935 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9936 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9937 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9939 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9940 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9941 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9942 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9943 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9945 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9946 @section The export dispatcher
9947 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9949 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9950 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9951 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9952 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9953 the subtrees are exported.
9956 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9957 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9958 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9959 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9960 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9961 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9962 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9963 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9964 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9965 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9966 (i.e., not hidden by outline visibility).
9967 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9968 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9969 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9970 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e., request background processing if
9971 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9974 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9975 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9976 @cindex ASCII export
9977 @cindex Latin-1 export
9978 @cindex UTF-8 export
9980 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9981 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9982 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9984 @cindex region, active
9985 @cindex active region
9986 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9988 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9989 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9990 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9991 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9992 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9993 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9994 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9995 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9996 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9997 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9999 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10000 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10001 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10002 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10003 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10004 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10005 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10006 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10007 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10008 Export only the visible part of the document.
10011 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10012 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10013 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10014 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10015 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10018 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10022 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10023 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10024 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10025 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10026 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10027 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10028 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10030 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10031 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10032 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10033 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10035 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10036 @section HTML export
10037 @cindex HTML export
10039 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10040 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10041 language, but with additional support for tables.
10044 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10045 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10046 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10047 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10048 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10049 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10050 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10051 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10052 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10053 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10056 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10057 @subsection HTML export commands
10059 @cindex region, active
10060 @cindex active region
10061 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10063 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10064 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10065 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10066 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10067 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10068 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10069 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10070 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10071 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10072 property, that name will be used for the export.
10073 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10074 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10075 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10076 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10077 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10078 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10079 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10080 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10081 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10082 Export only the visible part of the document.
10083 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10084 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10085 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10087 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10088 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10092 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10093 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10094 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10095 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10096 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10099 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10103 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10106 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10107 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10108 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10109 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10110 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10111 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10112 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10113 @vindex org-export-author-info
10114 @vindex org-export-email-info
10115 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10116 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10118 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10120 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10121 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10122 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10124 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10125 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10126 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10127 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10128 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10129 insert any preamble.
10131 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10132 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10133 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10134 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10135 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10136 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10137 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10138 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10139 insert any postamble.
10141 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10142 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10144 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
10145 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10146 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10147 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10148 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10149 the exported file use either
10152 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10154 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10158 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10162 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10167 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10168 @subsection Links in HTML export
10170 @cindex links, in HTML export
10171 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10172 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10173 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
10174 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10175 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10176 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10177 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10178 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10179 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10180 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10181 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10183 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10184 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10185 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10186 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10188 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10190 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10191 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10194 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10196 @cindex tables, in HTML
10197 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10199 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10200 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10201 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10202 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10205 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10207 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10208 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10211 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10212 @subsection Images in HTML export
10214 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10215 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10216 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10217 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10218 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10219 default@footnote{But see the variable
10220 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10221 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10222 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10223 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10224 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10225 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10226 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10227 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10230 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10233 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10234 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10235 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10238 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10240 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10241 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10246 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10248 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10249 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10253 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10254 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10255 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10256 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10257 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10258 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10259 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10260 found on the MathJax website, see
10261 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10262 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10263 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10264 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10267 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10270 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10271 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10274 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10275 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10276 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10277 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10278 You can still get this processing with
10281 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10284 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10285 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10287 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10288 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10289 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10290 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10291 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10292 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10293 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10294 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10295 respectively. For example
10298 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10299 (defun org-xor (a b)
10306 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10307 @subsection CSS support
10308 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10309 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10311 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10312 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10313 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10314 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10315 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10316 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10317 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10318 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10319 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10321 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10322 p.date @r{publishing date}
10323 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10324 .title @r{document title}
10325 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10326 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10327 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10328 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10329 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10330 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10331 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10332 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10333 .target @r{target for links}
10334 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10335 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10336 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10337 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10338 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10339 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10340 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10341 pre.example @r{normal example}
10342 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10343 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10344 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10345 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10346 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10349 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10350 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10351 @vindex org-export-html-style
10352 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10353 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10354 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10355 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10356 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10357 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10358 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10359 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10360 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10361 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10362 individually for each file, you can use
10366 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10370 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10371 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10372 referring to an external file.
10374 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10375 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10376 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10379 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10380 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10382 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10383 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10385 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10386 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10387 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10388 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10389 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10390 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10391 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10392 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10393 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10394 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10395 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10396 not want to be dependent on @url{http://orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10397 copy on your own web server.
10399 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10400 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10401 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10402 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10403 adding a single line to the Org file:
10405 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10407 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10411 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10412 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10416 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10417 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10418 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10419 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10420 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10421 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10422 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10423 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10424 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10425 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10426 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10427 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10428 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10429 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10430 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10431 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10432 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10433 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10434 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10435 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10436 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10437 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10438 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10439 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10440 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10443 @vindex org-infojs-options
10444 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10445 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10446 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10447 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10449 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10450 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10451 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10453 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10455 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10456 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10457 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10458 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10459 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10460 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10461 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10462 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10463 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10464 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10468 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10469 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10470 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10471 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10472 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10473 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10476 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10477 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10479 @cindex region, active
10480 @cindex active region
10481 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10483 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10484 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10485 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10486 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10487 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10488 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10489 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10490 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10491 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10492 property, that name will be used for the export.
10493 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10494 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10495 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10496 Export only the visible part of the document.
10497 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10498 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10499 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10501 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10502 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10504 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10505 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10506 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10507 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10510 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10511 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10512 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10513 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10514 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10515 convert them to a custom string depending on
10516 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10518 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10519 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10522 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10526 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10528 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10529 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10530 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10531 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10532 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10533 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10534 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10536 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10538 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10539 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10540 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10541 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10542 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10543 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10544 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10545 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10546 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10547 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10548 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10549 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10550 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10551 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10552 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10553 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10554 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10555 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10556 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10557 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10558 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10559 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10560 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10561 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10565 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10566 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10567 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10573 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10574 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10576 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10577 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10578 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10579 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10580 the following constructs:
10583 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10585 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10589 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10593 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10598 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10599 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10600 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10602 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10603 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10604 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10605 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10606 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10607 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10608 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10613 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10615 #+CAPTION: A long table
10617 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10622 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10626 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10628 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10630 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10635 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10636 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10637 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10638 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10640 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10641 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10642 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10643 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10644 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10645 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10646 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10647 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10648 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10649 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10650 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10651 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10652 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10653 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10654 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10655 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10657 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10658 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10659 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10660 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10661 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10662 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10666 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10668 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10669 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10670 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10671 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10673 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10677 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10678 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10679 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10681 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10682 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10684 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10685 @subsection Beamer class export
10687 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10688 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10689 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10691 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10692 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10693 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10694 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10695 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10696 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10697 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10698 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10699 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10700 structure of the presentation.
10702 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10703 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10704 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10705 editing special properties used by beamer.
10707 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10712 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10713 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10714 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10715 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10716 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10717 @item BEAMER_envargs
10718 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10719 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10720 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10721 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10722 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10725 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10726 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10727 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10728 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10729 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10730 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10731 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10732 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10734 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10735 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10739 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10740 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10741 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10742 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10743 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10744 in the presentation as well.
10746 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10747 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10748 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10749 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10750 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10751 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10752 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10754 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10762 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10763 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10764 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10767 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10768 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10769 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10770 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10772 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10775 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10776 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10777 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10778 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10779 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10780 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10781 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10783 * This is the first structural section
10785 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10786 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10789 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10792 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10793 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10797 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10799 for contributing to the discussion
10800 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10801 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10802 *** Request :B_block:
10803 Please test this stuff!
10809 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10811 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10812 @section DocBook export
10813 @cindex DocBook export
10815 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10817 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10818 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10819 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10820 tools and stylesheets.
10822 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10825 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10826 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10827 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10828 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10829 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10830 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10833 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10834 @subsection DocBook export commands
10836 @cindex region, active
10837 @cindex active region
10838 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10840 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10841 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10842 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10843 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10844 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10845 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10846 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10847 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10848 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10849 property, that name will be used for the export.
10850 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10851 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10853 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10854 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10855 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10856 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10857 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10858 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10860 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10861 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10862 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10863 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10864 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10865 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10867 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10868 Export only the visible part of the document.
10871 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10872 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10874 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10875 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10878 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10880 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10884 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10888 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10893 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10894 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10895 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10896 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10901 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10902 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10903 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10908 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10909 @subsection Recursive sections
10910 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10912 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10913 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e., @code{section} elements, are
10914 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10915 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10916 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10917 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10919 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10920 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10922 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10923 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10924 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10926 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10929 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10930 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10931 using the @code{table} element.
10933 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10934 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10935 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10936 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10938 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10939 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10940 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10941 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10942 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10943 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10944 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10945 @code{mediaobject} element.
10947 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10948 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10949 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10950 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10951 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10952 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10953 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10954 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10956 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10957 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10958 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10959 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10960 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10965 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10967 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10968 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10969 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10970 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10973 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10974 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10975 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10976 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10977 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10979 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10980 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10981 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10983 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10984 @vindex org-entities
10985 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10986 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10987 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10988 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10989 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10990 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10992 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10993 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10994 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10995 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10998 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10999 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11000 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11001 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11008 @c begin opendocument
11010 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11011 @section OpenDocument Text export
11012 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11014 @cindex OpenDocument
11015 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11016 @cindex LibreOffice
11018 @cindex org-modules
11020 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11021 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11022 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11023 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11024 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11025 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11028 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11029 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11030 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11031 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11032 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11033 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11034 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11035 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11036 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11037 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11038 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11041 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11042 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11044 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11045 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11047 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11048 @subsection ODT export commands
11050 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11051 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11053 @cindex region, active
11054 @cindex active region
11055 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11057 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11058 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11060 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11062 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11063 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11064 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11065 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11067 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11068 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11069 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11070 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11071 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11072 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11073 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11076 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11077 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11079 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11080 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11081 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11082 exporting to other formats}.
11085 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11086 @subsection Extending ODT export
11088 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11089 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11090 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11091 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11093 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11094 @cindex LibreOffice
11095 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11096 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11097 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11098 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11099 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11100 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11101 document converter}.
11103 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11104 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11106 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11107 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11108 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11109 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11110 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11111 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11112 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11113 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11115 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11116 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11118 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11119 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11120 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11121 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11122 the following command.
11124 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11127 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11128 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11129 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11132 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11133 @subsection Applying custom styles
11134 @cindex styles, custom
11135 @cindex template, custom
11137 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11138 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11139 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11140 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11141 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11142 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11143 users alike, and is described here.
11145 @subsubsection Applying custom styles: the easy way
11149 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11153 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11157 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11158 to locate the target styles---these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix---and
11159 modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11160 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11163 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11164 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11165 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11166 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11167 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11169 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11170 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11173 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11179 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11184 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11186 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11187 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11188 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11189 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11190 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11191 the factory settings.
11193 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11194 @subsection Links in ODT export
11195 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11197 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11198 Internet-style links for all other links.
11200 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11201 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11203 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11204 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11205 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11207 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11208 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11209 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11211 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11212 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables---tables
11213 that have column or row spans---is not supported. Such tables are
11214 stripped from the exported document.
11216 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11217 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11218 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11219 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11220 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11221 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11224 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11225 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11227 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11231 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11232 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11233 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11235 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11236 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11237 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11238 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11239 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11240 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11243 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11244 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11245 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11246 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11247 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11249 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11250 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11251 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11253 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11254 @subsection Images in ODT export
11255 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11256 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11258 @subsubheading Embedding images
11259 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11260 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11261 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11271 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11272 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11273 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11274 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11275 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11278 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11281 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11284 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11285 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11287 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11288 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11289 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11290 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11291 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11292 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11293 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11294 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11295 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11296 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11297 converted in to units of centimeters using
11298 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11299 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11300 achieve the best results.
11302 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11305 @item Explicitly size the image
11306 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11309 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11313 @item Scale the image
11314 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11317 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11321 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11322 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11323 height:width ratio, do the following:
11326 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11330 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11331 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11332 height:width ratio, do the following
11335 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11340 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11343 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11344 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11345 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property:
11346 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11348 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11350 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11354 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11355 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11357 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11360 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11361 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11364 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11365 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11367 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11368 document in one of the following ways:
11374 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11380 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11381 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11382 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11383 the exported document.
11385 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11386 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11388 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11389 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11390 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11392 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11393 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11394 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11397 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11398 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11399 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11400 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11403 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11404 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11408 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11409 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11411 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11412 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11413 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11419 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11422 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11425 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11426 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11427 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11430 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11431 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11433 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11434 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11435 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11436 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11448 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11449 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11451 You can label and caption various category of objects---an inline image, a
11452 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula---using @code{#+LABEL} and
11453 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11454 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11455 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11456 appearance in the Org file.
11458 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11459 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11463 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11464 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11468 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11471 Figure 2: Bell curve
11474 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11475 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11476 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11477 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11478 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11481 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11482 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11485 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11489 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11492 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11493 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11495 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11496 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11497 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11498 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11499 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11500 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11501 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11503 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11504 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11505 by customizing the variable
11506 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11508 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11509 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11510 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11512 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11513 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11515 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11516 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11517 that would be of interest to power users.
11520 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11521 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11522 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11523 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11524 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11527 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11528 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11530 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11533 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11534 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11535 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11536 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11539 @item Register the converter
11541 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11542 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11543 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11544 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11546 @item Configure its capabilities
11548 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11549 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11550 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11551 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11552 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11553 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11554 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11555 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11557 @item Choose the converter
11559 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11560 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11561 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11564 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11565 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11566 @cindex styles, custom
11567 @cindex template, custom
11569 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11570 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11571 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11574 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11575 @subsubheading Factory styles
11577 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11578 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11579 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11582 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11584 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11586 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11587 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11591 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11594 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11598 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11600 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11602 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11603 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11604 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11606 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11607 file serves the following purposes:
11611 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11615 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11616 elements that control how various entities---tables, images, equations,
11617 etc.---are numbered.
11621 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11622 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11623 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11624 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11625 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11629 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11631 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11633 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11634 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11637 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11639 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11641 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11643 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11646 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11648 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11649 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11650 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11652 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11653 like header and footer images.
11657 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11660 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11662 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11664 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11665 in the final output.
11668 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11669 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11671 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11672 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11673 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11676 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11678 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11679 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11682 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11683 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11687 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11688 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11689 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11692 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11693 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11697 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11699 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11700 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11703 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11706 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11707 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11708 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11711 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11712 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11713 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11717 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11719 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11720 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11722 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11727 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11728 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11735 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11736 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11737 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11740 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11741 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11742 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11744 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11746 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11747 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11751 @subsubheading Custom table styles: an illustration
11753 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11754 the table that follows.
11757 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11758 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11759 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11760 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11761 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11762 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11763 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11764 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11768 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11769 | Name | Phone | Age |
11770 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11771 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11774 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11775 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11776 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11777 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11778 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11779 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11780 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11781 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11783 @subsubheading Custom table styles: the nitty-gritty
11784 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11788 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11789 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11791 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11792 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11806 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11807 template using a well-defined convention.
11809 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11810 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11811 the following table.
11813 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11814 @headitem Table cell type
11815 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11816 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11821 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11822 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11824 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11825 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11827 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11828 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11830 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11831 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11833 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11834 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11836 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11837 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11839 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11840 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11842 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11843 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11845 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11846 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11849 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11851 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11852 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11856 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11857 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11858 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11859 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11860 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11861 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11863 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11864 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11865 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11868 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11869 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11872 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11873 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11874 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11875 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11878 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11879 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11880 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11881 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11882 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11883 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11884 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11885 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11889 Associate a table with the table style
11891 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11892 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11895 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11896 | Name | Phone | Age |
11897 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11898 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11902 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11903 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11905 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11906 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11907 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11908 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11909 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11911 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11912 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11913 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11914 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11916 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11917 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11918 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11919 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11920 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11921 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11923 @c end opendocument
11925 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11926 @section TaskJuggler export
11927 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11928 @cindex Project management
11930 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11931 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11932 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11935 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11936 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11937 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11940 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11941 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11942 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11945 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11948 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11949 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11951 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11952 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11957 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11958 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11959 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11960 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11961 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11962 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11963 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11964 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11965 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11966 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11968 @subsection Resources
11970 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11971 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11972 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11973 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11974 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11975 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11976 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11977 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11978 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11979 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11980 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11981 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11982 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11984 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11985 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11988 @subsection Export of properties
11990 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e., if a
11991 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
11992 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
11993 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
11994 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
11995 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
11996 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
11997 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
11998 @samp{scheduling}, etc.@: for tasks.
12000 @subsection Dependencies
12002 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12003 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12004 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12005 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12006 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12007 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12008 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12009 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12010 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12011 examples should illustrate this:
12016 :task_id: preparation
12019 * Training material
12021 :task_id: training_material
12024 ** Markup Guidelines
12028 ** Workflow Guidelines
12035 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12039 @subsection Reports
12041 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12042 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g., gantt chart, resource
12043 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12044 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12045 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12046 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12047 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12048 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12050 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12051 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12053 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12054 @section Freemind export
12055 @cindex Freemind export
12058 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12061 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12062 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12063 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12066 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12067 @section XOXO export
12068 @cindex XOXO export
12070 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12071 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12072 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12075 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12076 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12077 @file{myfile.html}.
12078 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12079 Export only the visible part of the document.
12082 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12083 @section iCalendar export
12084 @cindex iCalendar export
12086 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12087 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12088 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12089 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12090 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12091 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12092 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12093 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12094 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12095 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12096 included in the export, configure the variable
12097 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12098 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12099 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12100 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12101 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12102 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12103 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12104 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12105 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12108 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12109 @cindex property, ID
12110 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12111 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12112 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12113 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12114 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12115 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12116 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12117 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12118 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12121 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12122 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12123 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12124 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12125 @vindex org-agenda-files
12126 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12127 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12128 file will be written.
12129 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12130 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12131 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12132 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12133 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12136 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12137 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12138 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12139 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12140 @cindex property, LOCATION
12141 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12142 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12143 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12144 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12145 and the description from the body (limited to
12146 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12148 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12149 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12151 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12152 @chapter Publishing
12155 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12156 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12157 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12158 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12161 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12162 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12164 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12167 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12168 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12169 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12170 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12173 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12174 @section Configuration
12176 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12177 and many other properties of a project.
12180 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12181 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12182 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12183 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12184 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12185 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12186 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12187 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12190 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12191 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12192 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12193 @cindex projects, for publishing
12195 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12196 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12197 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12198 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12201 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12202 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12204 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12208 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12209 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12210 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12211 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12212 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12213 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12214 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12217 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12218 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12219 @cindex directories, for publishing
12221 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12222 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12223 and where to put published files.
12225 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12226 @item @code{:base-directory}
12227 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12228 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12229 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12230 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12231 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12232 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12233 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12234 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12235 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12236 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12237 variable @code{project-plist}.
12238 @item @code{:completion-function}
12239 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12240 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12241 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12242 @code{project-plist}.
12246 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12247 @subsection Selecting files
12248 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12250 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12251 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12253 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12254 @item @code{:base-extension}
12255 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12256 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12257 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12259 @item @code{:exclude}
12260 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12261 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12264 @item @code{:include}
12265 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12266 and @code{:exclude}.
12268 @item @code{:recursive}
12269 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12272 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12273 @subsection Publishing action
12274 @cindex action, for publishing
12276 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12277 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12278 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12279 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12280 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12281 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12282 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12283 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12284 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12285 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12286 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12287 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12288 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12289 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12290 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12291 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12292 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12293 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12294 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12296 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12297 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12298 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12299 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12300 @item @code{:plain-source}
12301 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12302 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12303 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12306 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12307 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12308 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12309 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12310 and place the result into the destination folder.
12312 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12313 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12314 @cindex options, for publishing
12316 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12317 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12318 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12319 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12320 respective variable for details.
12322 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12323 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12324 @vindex org-export-default-language
12325 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12326 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12327 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12328 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12329 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12330 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12331 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12332 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12333 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12334 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12335 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12336 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12337 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12338 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12339 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12340 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12341 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12342 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12343 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12344 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12345 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12346 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12347 @vindex org-export-author-info
12348 @vindex org-export-email-info
12349 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12350 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12351 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12352 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12353 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12354 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12355 @vindex org-export-html-style
12356 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12357 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12358 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12359 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12360 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12361 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12362 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12363 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12364 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12365 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12366 @vindex user-full-name
12367 @vindex user-mail-address
12368 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12369 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12371 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12372 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12373 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12374 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12375 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12376 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12377 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12378 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12379 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12380 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12381 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12382 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12383 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12384 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12385 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12386 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12387 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12388 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12389 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12390 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12391 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12392 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12393 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12394 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12395 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12396 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12397 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12398 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12399 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12400 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12401 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12402 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12403 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12404 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12405 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12406 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12407 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12408 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12409 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12410 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12411 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12412 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12413 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12414 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12415 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12416 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12417 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12418 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12419 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12420 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12423 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12424 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12425 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12426 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12431 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12432 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12433 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12434 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12435 options}), however, override everything.
12437 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12438 @subsection Links between published files
12439 @cindex links, publishing
12441 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12442 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12443 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12444 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12445 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12446 you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12447 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12448 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12451 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12452 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12453 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12454 an example of this usage.
12456 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12457 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12458 location. In this case, use the property
12460 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12461 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12462 @tab Function to validate links
12466 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12467 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12468 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12469 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12470 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12471 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12472 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12474 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12475 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12476 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12478 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12479 a map of files for a given project.
12481 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12482 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12483 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12484 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12486 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12487 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12488 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12490 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12491 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12493 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12494 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12495 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12496 of links to all files in the project.
12498 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12499 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12500 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12501 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12503 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12504 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12505 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12506 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12507 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12508 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12509 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12511 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12512 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12514 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12515 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12516 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12517 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12518 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12519 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12520 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12522 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12523 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12524 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12525 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12527 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12528 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12529 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12530 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12534 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12535 @subsection Generating an index
12536 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12538 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12540 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12541 @item @code{:makeindex}
12542 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12543 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12546 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12547 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12548 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12549 a title, style information, etc.
12551 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12552 @section Uploading files
12556 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12557 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12558 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12559 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12560 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12563 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12564 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12565 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12566 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12567 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12569 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12570 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12571 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12572 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12573 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12574 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12577 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12578 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12579 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12580 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12581 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12582 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12584 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12585 @section Sample configuration
12587 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12588 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12589 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12592 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12593 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12596 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12597 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12599 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12600 directory on the local machine.
12603 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12605 :base-directory "~/org/"
12606 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12607 :section-numbers nil
12608 :table-of-contents nil
12609 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12610 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12611 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12614 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12615 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12617 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12618 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12619 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12622 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12623 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12624 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12625 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12628 file:../images/myimage.png
12631 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12632 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12633 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12636 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12638 :base-directory "~/org/"
12639 :base-extension "org"
12640 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12641 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12642 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12644 :section-numbers nil
12645 :table-of-contents nil
12646 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12647 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12651 :base-directory "~/images/"
12652 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12653 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12654 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12657 :base-directory "~/other/"
12658 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12659 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12660 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12661 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12664 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12665 @section Triggering publication
12667 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12670 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12671 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12672 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12673 Publish the project containing the current file.
12674 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12675 Publish only the current file.
12676 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12677 Publish every project.
12680 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12681 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12682 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12683 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12684 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12685 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12686 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12688 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12689 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12691 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12692 @chapter Working with source code
12693 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12694 @cindex Davison, Dan
12695 @cindex source code, working with
12697 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12701 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12702 (defun org-xor (a b)
12708 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12709 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12710 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12711 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12712 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12713 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12715 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12718 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12719 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12720 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12721 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12722 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12723 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12724 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12725 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12726 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12727 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12728 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12729 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12732 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12733 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12735 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12736 @section Structure of code blocks
12737 @cindex code block, structure
12738 @cindex source code, block structure
12740 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12742 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12743 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12744 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12748 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12753 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12754 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12755 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12756 @cindex source code, inline
12758 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12761 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12767 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12771 @item <#+NAME: name>
12772 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12773 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12774 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12775 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12776 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12777 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12781 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12782 @cindex source code, language
12784 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12785 @ref{Literal examples})
12786 @cindex source code, switches
12787 @item <header arguments>
12788 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12789 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12790 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12791 basis using properties.
12792 @item source code, header arguments
12794 Source code in the specified language.
12797 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12798 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12800 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12801 @section Editing source code
12802 @cindex code block, editing
12803 @cindex source code, editing
12806 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12807 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12808 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12809 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12811 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12812 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12813 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12814 further configuration options.
12817 @item org-src-lang-modes
12818 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12819 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12820 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12821 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12822 @item org-src-window-setup
12823 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12824 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12825 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12826 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12827 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12828 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12829 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12832 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12833 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12835 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12836 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12838 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12839 @section Exporting code blocks
12840 @cindex code block, exporting
12841 @cindex source code, exporting
12843 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12844 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12845 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12846 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12847 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12848 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12850 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12853 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12855 @item :exports code
12856 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12857 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12858 @item :exports results
12859 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12860 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12861 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12862 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12863 block will not be exported.
12864 @item :exports both
12865 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12866 @item :exports none
12867 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12870 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12871 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12872 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12873 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12874 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12875 markup language for a wiki.
12877 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12878 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12879 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12880 @section Extracting source code
12882 @cindex source code, extracting
12883 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12885 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12886 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12887 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12888 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12889 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12891 @subsubheading Header arguments
12894 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12896 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12897 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12898 for the block language.
12899 @item :tangle filename
12900 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12904 @subsubheading Functions
12906 @item org-babel-tangle
12907 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12908 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12909 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12912 @subsubheading Hooks
12914 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12915 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12916 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12917 of tangled code files.
12920 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12921 @section Evaluating code blocks
12922 @cindex code block, evaluating
12923 @cindex source code, evaluating
12926 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12927 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12928 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12929 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12930 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12931 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12932 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12933 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12934 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12935 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12937 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12938 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12939 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12940 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12941 used to define a code block).
12944 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12945 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12946 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12947 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12948 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12949 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12952 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12953 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12954 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12955 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12956 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12958 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12961 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12962 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12965 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12968 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12969 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12974 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12976 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12977 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12978 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12979 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12980 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12981 @item <inside header arguments>
12982 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12983 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12984 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12985 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12986 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12987 @item <end header arguments>
12988 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12989 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12990 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12991 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
12992 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
12994 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
12995 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
12998 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
12999 @section Library of Babel
13000 @cindex babel, library of
13001 @cindex source code, library
13002 @cindex code block, library
13004 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13005 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13006 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13007 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13010 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13011 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13013 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13014 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13015 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13019 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13020 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13023 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13025 @cindex babel, languages
13026 @cindex source code, languages
13027 @cindex code block, languages
13029 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13031 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13032 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13033 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13034 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13035 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13036 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13037 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13038 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13039 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13040 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13041 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13042 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13043 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13044 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13045 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13046 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13047 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13048 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13049 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13050 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13053 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13054 available, it can be found at
13055 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13057 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13058 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13059 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13060 to your emacs configuration.
13063 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13064 @code{R} code blocks.
13068 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13069 'org-babel-load-languages
13070 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13074 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13075 elisp file with @code{require}.
13078 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13082 (require 'ob-clojure)
13085 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13086 @section Header arguments
13087 @cindex code block, header arguments
13088 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13090 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13091 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13092 describes each header argument in detail.
13095 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13096 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13099 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13100 @subsection Using header arguments
13102 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13103 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13105 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13106 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13107 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13108 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13109 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13110 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13114 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13115 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13116 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13117 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13118 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13122 :results => "replace"
13129 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13131 @c ((:session . "none")
13132 @c (:results . "replace")
13133 @c (:exports . "code")
13135 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13139 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13142 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13143 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13144 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13148 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13149 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13150 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13153 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13154 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13155 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13156 language-specific documentation available online at
13157 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13159 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13160 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13161 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13162 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13163 @ref{Property syntax}).
13165 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13166 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13167 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13168 inserted into the buffer.
13171 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13172 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13175 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13176 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13178 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13179 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13180 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13183 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13186 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13187 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13188 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13189 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13190 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13191 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13201 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13202 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13203 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13204 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13205 in Org mode documents.
13207 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13208 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13210 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13211 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13212 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13213 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13214 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13215 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13216 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13217 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13218 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13219 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13223 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13225 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13228 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13231 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13234 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13235 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13236 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13240 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13243 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13244 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13245 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13252 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13255 #+NAME: named-block
13256 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13257 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13258 (message "data:%S" data)
13261 #+RESULTS: named-block
13265 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13266 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13267 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13269 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13270 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13271 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13274 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13275 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13278 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13281 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13282 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13285 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13288 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13289 @subsection Specific header arguments
13290 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13291 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13294 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13295 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13296 be collected and handled
13297 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13298 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13299 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13300 directory for code block execution
13301 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13302 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13303 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13304 files during tangling
13305 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13307 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13309 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13310 expansion during tangling
13311 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13312 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13313 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13314 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13315 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13316 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13317 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13318 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13319 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13320 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13321 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13322 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13325 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13328 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13329 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13330 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13331 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13332 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13333 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13334 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13336 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13337 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13338 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13339 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13340 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13343 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13344 Indexable variable values}).
13346 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13347 @code{:var} header argument.
13353 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13354 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13355 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13356 results of evaluating another code block.
13358 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13363 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13366 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13372 #+NAME: table-length
13373 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13377 #+RESULTS: table-length
13382 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13383 carried through to the source code block)
13386 #+NAME: example-list
13392 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13400 @item code block without arguments
13401 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13402 optionally followed by parentheses
13405 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13413 @item code block with arguments
13414 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13415 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13416 code block name using standard function call syntax
13420 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13428 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13436 @item literal example
13437 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13440 #+NAME: literal-example
13446 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13447 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13448 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13451 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13452 : A literal example
13453 : on two lines for you.
13459 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13460 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13461 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13462 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13463 following the source name.
13466 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13467 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13472 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13473 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13474 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13475 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13476 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13477 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13478 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13479 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13480 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13483 #+NAME: example-table
13489 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13497 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13498 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13499 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13503 #+NAME: example-table
13510 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13520 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13521 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13522 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13523 column is referenced.
13526 #+NAME: example-table
13532 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13540 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13541 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13542 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13546 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13547 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13548 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13549 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13552 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13560 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13562 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13563 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13564 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13565 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13566 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13567 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13568 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13569 evaluation of the code block body.
13572 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13577 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13578 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13584 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13593 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13594 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13596 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13597 per class may be supplied per code block.
13601 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13602 from the code block
13604 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13605 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13608 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13609 block should be handled.
13612 @subsubheading Collection
13613 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13614 should be collected from the code block.
13618 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13619 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13620 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13621 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13622 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13623 @item @code{output}
13624 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13625 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13626 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13629 @subsubheading Type
13631 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13632 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13633 table or scalar depending on their value.
13636 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13637 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13638 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13639 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13641 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13642 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13643 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13644 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13645 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13646 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13648 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13649 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13651 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13652 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13653 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13655 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13656 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13657 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13659 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13660 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13662 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13663 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13665 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13666 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13668 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13669 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13670 @code{:results value pp}.
13671 @item @code{drawer}
13672 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13673 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13674 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13677 @subsubheading Handling
13678 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13679 results once they are collected.
13682 @item @code{silent}
13683 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13684 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13685 @item @code{replace}
13686 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13687 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13688 @code{:results output replace}.
13689 @item @code{append}
13690 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13691 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13692 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13693 @item @code{prepend}
13694 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13695 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13696 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13699 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13700 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13702 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13703 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13704 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13705 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13706 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13707 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13708 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13709 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13711 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13712 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13713 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13715 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13716 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13718 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13719 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13720 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13721 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13722 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13724 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13725 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13727 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13728 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13729 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13730 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13731 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13732 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13733 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13735 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13736 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13737 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13739 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13740 in your home directory, you could use
13743 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13744 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13748 @subsubheading Remote execution
13749 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13750 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13753 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13754 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13758 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13759 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13760 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13763 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13764 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13767 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13770 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13771 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13772 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13773 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13775 @subsubheading Further points
13779 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13780 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13781 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13783 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13784 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13785 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13786 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13787 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13788 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13789 which the link does not point.
13792 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13793 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13795 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13796 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13800 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13801 @code{:exports code}.
13802 @item @code{results}
13803 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13804 @code{:exports results}.
13806 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13807 @code{:exports both}.
13809 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13812 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13813 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13815 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13816 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13819 @item @code{tangle}
13820 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13821 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13822 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13824 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13825 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13827 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13828 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13829 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13832 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13833 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13835 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13836 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13837 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13839 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13840 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13841 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13842 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13843 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13844 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13848 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13850 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13851 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13853 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13855 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13857 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13858 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13860 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13862 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13863 references in the code block body in link comments.
13866 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13867 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13868 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13869 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13870 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13875 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13877 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13880 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13881 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13883 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13884 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13885 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13886 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13887 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13889 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13890 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13892 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13893 language where state is preserved.
13895 By default, a session is not started.
13897 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13898 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13899 interpreted language.
13901 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13902 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13904 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13905 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13906 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13907 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13908 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13912 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13913 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13915 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13916 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13917 @item @code{tangle}
13918 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13919 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13920 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13921 @item @code{no-export}
13922 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13923 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13924 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13925 @item @code{strip-export}
13926 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13927 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13928 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13930 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13931 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13934 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13935 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13936 @code{<<reference>>}.
13937 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13938 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13939 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13951 -- multi-line body of example
13954 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13955 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13958 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13959 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13960 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13961 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13962 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13963 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13965 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13966 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13967 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13968 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13969 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13973 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13976 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13978 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13981 ** query all mounted disks
13986 ** strip the header row
13991 ** sort by the percent full
13993 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
13996 ** extract the mount point
13998 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14002 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14003 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14006 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14007 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14009 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14010 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14013 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14014 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14016 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14017 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14018 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14019 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14020 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14021 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14022 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14026 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14027 every time it is called.
14029 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14030 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14031 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14032 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14033 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14036 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14037 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14038 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14039 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14040 changed since it was last run.
14044 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14048 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14052 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14056 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14060 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14061 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14063 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14064 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14065 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14066 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14067 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14070 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14073 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14074 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14076 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14077 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14078 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14082 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14083 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14084 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14085 default value yields the following results.
14088 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14096 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14100 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14107 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14110 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14118 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14122 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14131 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14132 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14134 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14135 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14136 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14137 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14138 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14139 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14143 If an input table looks like it has column names
14144 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14145 names will be removed from the table before
14146 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14149 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14155 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14156 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14157 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14160 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14167 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14168 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14171 No column name pre-processing takes place
14174 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14175 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
14179 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14180 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14182 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14183 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14187 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14190 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14191 and is then reapplied to the results.
14194 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14195 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14196 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14198 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14199 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14200 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14203 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14204 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14205 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14208 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14209 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14213 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14214 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14216 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14217 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14218 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14219 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14221 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14222 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14223 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14224 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14225 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14226 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14227 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14228 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14232 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14234 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14235 @item never-export or no-export
14236 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14239 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14242 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14243 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14246 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14247 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14248 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14249 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14250 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14251 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14252 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14254 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14255 @section Results of evaluation
14256 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14257 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14259 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14260 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14261 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14262 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14264 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14265 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14266 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14267 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14270 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14271 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14272 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14274 @subsection Non-session
14275 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14276 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14277 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14278 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14279 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14280 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14281 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14283 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14284 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14286 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14287 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14288 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14289 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14292 @subsection Session
14293 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14294 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14295 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14296 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14297 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14298 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14299 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14300 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14302 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14303 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14304 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14305 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14308 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14309 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14310 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14311 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14312 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14313 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14314 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14317 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14328 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14331 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14343 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14344 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14347 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14348 @section Noweb reference syntax
14349 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14350 @cindex syntax, noweb
14351 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14353 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14354 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14355 familiar Noweb syntax:
14358 <<code-block-name>>
14361 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14362 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14363 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14364 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14365 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14366 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14368 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14369 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14370 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14373 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14376 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14377 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14378 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14379 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14382 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14383 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14384 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14385 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14388 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14389 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14390 @cindex code block, key bindings
14392 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14395 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14398 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14400 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14402 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14404 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14406 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14409 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14411 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14413 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14414 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14416 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14417 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14419 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14420 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14422 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14423 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14425 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14426 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14428 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14429 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14431 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14432 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14434 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14435 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14437 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14438 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14440 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14441 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14443 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14444 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14446 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14447 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14449 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14450 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14452 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14453 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14455 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14456 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14458 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14459 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14461 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14462 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14464 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14465 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14467 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14468 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14470 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14471 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14473 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14474 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14476 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14477 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14480 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14481 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14483 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14484 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14485 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14486 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14487 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14488 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14489 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14490 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14491 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14494 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14495 @section Batch execution
14496 @cindex code block, batch execution
14497 @cindex source code, batch execution
14499 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14500 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14502 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14506 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14508 # tangle files with org-mode
14513 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14515 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14520 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14521 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14522 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14523 (mapc (lambda (file)
14524 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14526 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14529 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14530 @chapter Miscellaneous
14533 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14534 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14535 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14536 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14537 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14538 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14539 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14540 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14541 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14542 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14543 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14547 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14548 @section Completion
14549 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14550 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14551 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14552 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14553 @cindex completion, of tags
14554 @cindex completion, of property keys
14555 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14556 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14557 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14558 @cindex dictionary word completion
14559 @cindex option keyword completion
14560 @cindex tag completion
14561 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14563 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14564 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14565 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14566 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14567 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14569 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14570 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14571 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14574 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14576 Complete word at point
14579 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14581 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14583 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14584 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14586 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14587 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14588 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14589 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14591 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14592 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14595 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14597 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14598 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14599 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14600 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14602 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14603 i.e., valid keys for this line.
14605 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14609 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14610 @section Easy Templates
14611 @cindex template insertion
14612 @cindex insertion, of templates
14614 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14615 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14616 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14617 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14618 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14620 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14621 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14622 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14624 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14626 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14627 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14628 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14629 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14630 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14631 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14632 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14633 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14634 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14635 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14636 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14637 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14638 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14639 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14642 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14643 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14645 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14646 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14647 additional details.
14649 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14650 @section Speed keys
14652 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14653 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14655 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14656 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
14657 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14658 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14659 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14660 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14661 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14662 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14664 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14665 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14667 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14668 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14670 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14672 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14673 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14674 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14675 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14676 these precautions intact.
14678 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14679 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14680 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14682 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14685 @item Source code blocks
14686 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14687 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14688 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14689 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14690 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14692 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14693 which take off the default security brakes.
14695 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14696 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14697 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14698 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14699 ask and nil not to ask.
14702 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14706 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14707 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14708 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14711 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14712 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14713 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14716 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14717 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14719 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14720 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14723 @item Formulas in tables
14724 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14725 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14728 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14729 @section Customization
14730 @cindex customization
14731 @cindex options, for customization
14732 @cindex variables, for customization
14734 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14735 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14736 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14737 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14738 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14739 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14740 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14742 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14743 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14744 @cindex in-buffer settings
14745 @cindex special keywords
14747 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14748 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14749 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14750 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14751 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14752 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14753 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14754 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14755 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14757 @vindex org-archive-location
14759 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14760 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14761 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14762 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14763 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14765 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14766 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14767 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14768 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14769 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14770 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14771 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14773 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14774 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14775 @vindex org-table-formula
14776 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14777 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14778 The global version of this variable is
14779 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14780 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14781 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14783 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14784 @vindex org-drawers
14785 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14786 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14787 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14788 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14789 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14790 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14791 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14792 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14793 @vindex org-highest-priority
14794 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14795 @vindex org-default-priority
14796 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14797 must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must
14798 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14799 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14800 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14801 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14802 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14803 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14804 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14805 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14806 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14807 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14808 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14809 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14810 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14813 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14814 Org file is being visited.
14816 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14817 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14818 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14820 @vindex org-startup-folded
14821 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14822 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14823 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14824 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14826 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14827 content @r{all headlines}
14828 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14829 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14832 @vindex org-startup-indented
14833 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14834 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14835 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14836 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14838 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14839 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14842 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14843 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14844 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14845 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14847 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14848 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14850 align @r{align all tables}
14851 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14854 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14855 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14856 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14857 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14858 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14859 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14861 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14862 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14865 @vindex org-log-done
14866 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14867 @vindex org-log-repeat
14868 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14869 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14870 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14871 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14872 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14873 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14874 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14875 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14876 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14877 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14878 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14879 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14880 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14881 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14882 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14883 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14884 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14885 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14886 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14887 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14889 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14890 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14891 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14892 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14893 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14894 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14895 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14896 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14897 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14898 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14899 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14900 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14901 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14902 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14903 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14904 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14905 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14907 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14908 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14909 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14910 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14911 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14912 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14913 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14914 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14915 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14916 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14918 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14919 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14920 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14921 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14922 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14923 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14925 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14926 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14927 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14928 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14929 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14930 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14932 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14934 @vindex constants-unit-system
14935 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14936 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14937 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14938 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14940 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14941 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14943 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14944 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14945 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14946 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14947 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14948 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14949 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14950 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14951 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14952 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14953 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14954 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14955 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14956 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14957 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14959 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14960 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14961 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14962 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14963 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14964 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14965 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14966 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14967 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14969 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14970 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14971 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14972 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14973 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14975 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14976 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14978 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14979 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14980 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14981 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14982 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14984 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14985 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14987 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14988 @vindex org-tag-alist
14989 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14990 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14991 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14993 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
14994 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
14995 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
14996 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
14997 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
14998 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
14999 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15000 @ref{Export options}.
15001 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15002 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15003 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15004 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15007 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15008 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15010 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15012 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15013 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15014 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15015 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15016 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15017 what this means in different contexts.
15021 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15022 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15024 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15025 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15028 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15029 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15031 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15034 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15035 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15038 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15039 corresponding links in this buffer.
15041 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15042 drawer, offer property commands.
15044 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15045 definition, and vice versa.
15047 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15049 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15052 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15055 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15058 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15061 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15062 @section A cleaner outline view
15063 @cindex hiding leading stars
15064 @cindex dynamic indentation
15065 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15066 @cindex clean outline view
15068 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15069 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15070 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15071 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15072 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15076 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15077 ** Second level | * Second level
15078 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15079 some text | some text
15080 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15081 more text | more text
15082 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15088 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15089 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15090 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15091 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15092 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15093 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15094 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15095 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15096 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15097 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15098 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15099 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15100 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15101 @code{nil}.}; see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15102 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15103 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15104 individual files using
15110 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15111 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15112 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15117 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15118 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15119 with the headline, like
15123 more text, now indented
15126 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15127 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15128 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15129 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15132 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15133 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15134 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15135 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15139 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15140 #+STARTUP: showstars
15143 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15147 * Top level headline
15155 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15156 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15157 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15158 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15159 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15160 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15161 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15164 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15165 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15166 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15167 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15168 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
15169 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15170 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15171 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15172 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15179 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15180 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15181 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15182 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15185 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15186 @section Using Org on a tty
15187 @cindex tty key bindings
15189 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15190 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15191 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15192 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15193 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15194 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15195 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15196 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15197 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15198 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15199 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15201 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15202 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15203 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15204 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15205 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15206 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15207 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15208 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15209 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15210 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15211 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15212 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15213 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15214 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15215 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15216 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15217 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15218 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15219 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15220 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15224 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15225 @section Interaction with other packages
15226 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15227 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15228 with other code out there.
15231 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15232 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15235 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15236 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15239 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15240 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15241 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15242 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15243 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15244 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15245 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15246 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15247 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15248 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15249 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15250 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15251 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15252 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15253 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15254 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15255 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15256 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15257 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15258 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15259 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15260 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15261 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15262 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15263 @file{constants.el}.
15264 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15265 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15266 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15267 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15268 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15269 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15270 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15271 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15272 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15274 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15275 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15277 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15278 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15279 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15280 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15281 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15282 @cindex Wiegley, John
15283 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15284 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15285 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15286 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15287 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15288 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15289 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15290 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15291 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15292 @cindex @file{table.el}
15293 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15295 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15296 @cindex @file{table.el}
15297 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15299 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15300 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15301 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15302 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15303 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15304 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15305 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15308 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15309 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15311 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15312 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15313 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15314 format. See the documentation string of the command
15315 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15318 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15319 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15320 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15321 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15322 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15323 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15324 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15327 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15328 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15332 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15333 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15334 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15335 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15336 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15337 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15338 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15339 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15340 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15341 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15342 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15343 cursor moves across a special context.
15345 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15346 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15347 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15348 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15349 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15350 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15351 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15352 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15353 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15354 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15355 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15356 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15357 buffer (but not during date selection).
15360 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15361 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15362 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15365 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15366 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15367 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15368 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15370 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15371 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15373 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15374 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15375 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15379 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15382 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15383 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15384 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15385 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15386 fixed this problem:
15389 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15391 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15392 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15395 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15396 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15400 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15401 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15404 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15407 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15409 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15410 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15411 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15412 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15415 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15416 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15417 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15418 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15419 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15420 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15424 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15425 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15426 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15427 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15428 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15431 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15432 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15434 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15435 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15436 another key for this command, or override the key in
15437 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15440 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15445 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15446 @section org-crypt.el
15447 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15448 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15450 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15451 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15454 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15455 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15456 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15458 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15462 (require 'org-crypt)
15463 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15464 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15466 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15467 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15468 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15470 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15471 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15472 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15473 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15476 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15478 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15481 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15482 being encrypted again.
15484 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15488 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15492 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15493 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15494 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15495 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15496 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15497 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15498 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15499 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15500 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15501 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15504 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15508 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15509 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15510 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15511 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15512 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15514 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15515 @section Add-on packages
15516 @cindex add-on packages
15518 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15519 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15520 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15521 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15522 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15523 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15527 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15528 @section Adding hyperlink types
15529 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15531 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15532 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15533 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15534 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15535 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15539 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15543 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15544 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15546 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15547 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15549 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15551 (defun org-man-open (path)
15552 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15553 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15554 (funcall org-man-command path))
15556 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15557 "Store a link to a manpage."
15558 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15559 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15560 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15561 (link (concat "man:" page))
15562 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15563 (org-store-link-props
15566 :description description))))
15568 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15569 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15570 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15571 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15572 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15573 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15577 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15581 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15588 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15591 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15594 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15595 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15596 that will be called to follow such a link.
15598 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15599 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15600 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15601 buffer displaying a man page.
15604 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15605 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15606 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15607 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15608 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15609 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15610 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15612 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15613 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15614 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15615 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15616 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15617 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15618 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15619 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15620 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15621 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15622 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15623 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15625 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15626 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
15627 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15628 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15630 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15631 @section Context-sensitive commands
15632 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15633 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15634 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15636 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15637 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15638 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15640 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15641 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15642 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15643 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15644 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15645 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15646 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15650 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15651 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15652 (if (save-excursion
15653 (beginning-of-line 1)
15654 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15655 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15656 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15657 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15659 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15662 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15663 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15664 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15665 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15666 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15669 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15670 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15671 @cindex tables, in other modes
15672 @cindex lists, in other modes
15673 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15675 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15676 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15677 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15678 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15679 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15682 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15683 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15684 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15685 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15686 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15687 for a very flexible system.
15689 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15690 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15691 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15692 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15696 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15697 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15698 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15699 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15702 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15703 @subsection Radio tables
15704 @cindex radio tables
15706 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15707 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15708 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15709 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15712 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15713 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15717 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15718 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15722 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15726 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15727 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15728 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15729 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15730 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15731 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15732 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15736 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15739 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15740 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15741 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15742 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15743 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15744 additional columns.
15747 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15748 the table. The default value is nil.
15752 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15753 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15754 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15755 number of different solutions:
15759 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15760 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15761 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15763 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15764 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15767 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15768 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15769 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15770 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15774 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15775 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15776 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15778 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15779 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15780 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15781 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15782 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15783 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15784 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15785 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15786 will then get the following template:
15788 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15790 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15791 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15793 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15799 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15800 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15801 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15802 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15803 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15804 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15805 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15806 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15807 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15808 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15809 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15810 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15813 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15814 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15816 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15817 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15818 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15819 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15820 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15821 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15822 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15823 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15828 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15829 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15831 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15832 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
15833 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15834 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
15835 header and footer commands of the target table:
15838 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15839 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15840 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15841 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15845 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15846 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15847 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15848 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15849 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15850 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15851 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15855 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15856 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15857 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15858 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15861 @item :splice nil/t
15862 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15863 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15866 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15867 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15868 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15869 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15870 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15871 function must return a formatted string.
15874 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15875 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15876 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15877 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15878 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15879 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15880 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15881 supplied instead of strings.
15884 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15885 @subsection Translator functions
15886 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15887 @cindex translator function
15889 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15890 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15891 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15892 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15893 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15894 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15895 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15896 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15897 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15901 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15902 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15903 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15904 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15907 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15908 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15909 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15910 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15911 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15915 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15916 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15917 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
15918 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15919 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15920 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15921 overrule the default with
15924 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15927 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15928 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15929 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15930 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15931 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15932 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15936 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15937 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15941 Please check the documentation string of the function
15942 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15943 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15944 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15945 using the generic function.
15947 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15948 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15949 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15950 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15951 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15952 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15953 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15954 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15955 others can benefit from your work.
15957 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15958 @subsection Radio lists
15959 @cindex radio lists
15960 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15962 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15963 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15964 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15965 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15967 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15971 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15973 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15975 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15978 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15981 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15986 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15987 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15989 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15998 Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
15999 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
16001 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16002 @section Dynamic blocks
16003 @cindex dynamic blocks
16005 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16006 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16007 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16008 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16010 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16011 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16012 the content of the block.
16014 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16016 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16021 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16024 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16025 Update dynamic block at point.
16026 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16027 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16030 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16031 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16032 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16033 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16034 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16036 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16037 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16038 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16039 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16043 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16049 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16052 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16053 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16054 (insert "Last block update at: "
16055 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16058 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16059 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16060 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16061 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16064 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16065 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16067 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16068 @section Special agenda views
16069 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16071 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16072 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16073 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16074 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16075 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16076 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16077 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16078 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16079 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16080 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16081 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16083 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16084 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16085 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16086 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16087 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16088 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16090 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16091 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16092 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16093 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16094 search should continue from there.
16097 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16098 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16099 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16100 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16101 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16102 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16105 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16109 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16110 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16111 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16112 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16115 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16116 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16117 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16119 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16120 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16121 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16122 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16123 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16124 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16125 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16126 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16127 you really want to have.
16129 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16130 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16131 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16134 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16135 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16136 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16137 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16138 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16139 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16140 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16141 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16142 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16143 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16144 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16145 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16146 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16147 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16148 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16149 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16150 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16151 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16152 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16153 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16154 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16157 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16158 like this, even without defining a special function:
16161 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16162 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16163 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16164 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16165 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16168 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16169 @section Extracting agenda information
16170 @cindex agenda, pipe
16171 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16173 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16174 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16175 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16176 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16177 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16178 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16179 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16180 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16181 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16182 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16183 current TODO list, you could use
16186 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16189 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16190 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16191 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16192 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16195 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16196 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16200 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16203 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16204 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16205 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16206 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16207 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16212 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16213 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16215 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16216 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16217 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16218 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16222 category @r{The category of the item}
16223 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16224 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16225 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16226 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16227 diary @r{imported from diary}
16228 deadline @r{a deadline}
16229 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16230 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16231 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16232 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16233 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16234 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16235 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16236 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16237 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16238 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16239 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16240 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16241 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16245 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16246 led to the selection of the item.
16248 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16249 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16250 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16255 # define the Emacs command to run
16256 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16258 # run it and capture the output
16259 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16261 # loop over all lines
16262 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16263 # get the individual values
16264 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16265 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16266 # process and print
16267 print "[ ] $head\n";
16271 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16272 @section Using the property API
16273 @cindex API, for properties
16274 @cindex properties, API
16276 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16279 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16280 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16281 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16282 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16283 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16284 if the property key was used several times.@*
16285 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16286 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16287 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16289 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16290 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16291 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16292 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM@. By default,
16293 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16294 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16295 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16296 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16297 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16300 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16301 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16304 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16305 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16308 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16309 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16312 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16313 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16316 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16317 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES@. VALUES should be a list of
16318 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16321 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16322 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16323 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16326 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16327 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16328 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16331 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16332 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16333 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16336 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16337 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16338 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16341 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16342 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16343 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16344 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16345 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16346 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16347 responsible for this property.
16350 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16351 @section Using the mapping API
16352 @cindex API, for mapping
16353 @cindex mapping entries, API
16355 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16356 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16357 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16358 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16361 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16362 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16364 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16365 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16366 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16367 returned as a list.
16369 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16370 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16371 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16372 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16373 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16374 if you have removed (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16375 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16376 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16377 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16380 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16381 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16382 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16383 visited by the iteration.
16385 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16388 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16389 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16390 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16391 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16393 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16394 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16395 agenda-with-archives
16396 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16398 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16401 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16402 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16404 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16406 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16407 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16408 function or Lisp form
16409 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16410 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16411 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16412 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16416 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16417 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16418 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16419 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16421 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16422 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16423 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16426 @defun org-priority &optional action
16427 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16428 possible values for ACTION.
16431 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16432 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16433 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16437 Promote the current entry.
16441 Demote the current entry.
16444 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16445 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16446 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16450 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16451 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16454 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16455 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16458 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16461 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16462 @appendix MobileOrg
16466 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16467 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16468 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16469 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16470 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16471 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16472 Moreland. Android users should check out
16473 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16474 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16477 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16478 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16479 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16481 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16482 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16483 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16484 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16485 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16486 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16487 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16490 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16491 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16492 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16495 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16496 @section Setting up the staging area
16498 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16499 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16500 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16501 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16502 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16503 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16504 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16505 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16506 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16507 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16508 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16510 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16511 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16512 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16513 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16514 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16515 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16516 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16520 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16523 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16524 and to read captured notes from there.
16526 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16527 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16529 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16530 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16531 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16532 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16533 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16534 inside this directory@footnote{Symbolic links in @code{org-directory} need to
16535 have the same name than their targets.}.
16537 The push operation also creates a special Org file @file{agendas.org} with
16538 all custom agenda view defined by the user@footnote{While creating the
16539 agendas, Org mode will force ID properties on all referenced entries, so that
16540 these entries can be uniquely identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for
16541 further action. If you do not want to get these properties in so many
16542 entries, you can set the variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}
16543 to @code{nil}. Org mode will then rely on outline paths, in the hope that
16544 these will be unique enough.}.
16546 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16547 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16548 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16549 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16550 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16552 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16553 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16555 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16556 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16557 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16558 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16559 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16563 Org moves all entries found in
16564 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16565 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16566 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16567 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16569 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16570 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16571 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16572 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16573 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16574 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16575 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16576 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16578 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16579 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16580 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16581 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16586 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16587 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16588 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16589 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16590 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16591 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16592 this flagged entry is finished.
16597 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16598 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16599 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16600 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16601 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16602 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16603 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16605 @node History and Acknowledgments, GNU Free Documentation License, MobileOrg, Top
16606 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16607 @cindex acknowledgments
16611 @section From Carsten
16613 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16614 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16615 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16616 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16617 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16618 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16619 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16620 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16621 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16622 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16623 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16624 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16625 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16626 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16627 functionality directly into a notes file.
16629 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16630 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16631 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16632 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16633 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16634 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16635 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16638 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16641 @item Bastien Guerry
16642 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16643 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16644 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16645 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16646 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16647 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16648 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16649 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16650 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16651 programming and reproducible research.
16653 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16654 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16655 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16656 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16657 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16658 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16659 @item Sebastian Rose
16660 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16661 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16662 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16663 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16664 single-key navigation.
16667 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16668 let me know what I am missing here!
16670 @section From Bastien
16672 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16673 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16674 to Carsten's ones above.
16676 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16677 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16678 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16680 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16681 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16682 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16683 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16684 either of the code or the community:
16688 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16689 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16691 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16692 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16693 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16694 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16696 @item Jambunathan K
16697 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitely a killer feature of
16698 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16699 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16700 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16703 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16704 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16705 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
16708 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16709 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16710 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16713 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16714 fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be
16715 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16717 @section List of contributions
16722 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16724 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16726 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16729 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16731 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16733 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16735 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16737 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16738 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16740 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16743 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16744 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16745 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16747 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16749 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16751 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16752 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16755 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16757 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16758 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16759 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16761 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16762 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16764 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16765 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16766 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16768 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16771 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16773 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16775 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16776 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16778 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16780 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16782 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16784 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16787 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16788 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16790 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16792 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16794 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16796 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16799 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16800 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16801 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16803 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16806 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16808 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16809 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16811 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16813 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16815 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16816 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16818 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16819 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16821 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16822 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16823 small fixes and patches.
16825 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16827 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16829 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16832 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16835 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16837 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16838 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16840 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16842 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16844 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16845 file links, and TAGS.
16847 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16848 version of the reference card.
16850 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16853 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16855 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16856 links, among other things.
16858 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16859 provided frequent feedback.
16861 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16862 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16864 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16866 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16869 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16870 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16872 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16874 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16875 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16877 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16880 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16881 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16883 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16886 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16888 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16889 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16891 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16892 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16894 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16895 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16897 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16900 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16902 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16903 tweaks and features.
16905 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16906 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16908 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16909 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16911 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16912 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16914 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16915 chapter about publishing.
16917 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16919 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16920 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16922 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16923 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16924 concept index for HTML export.
16926 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16929 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16931 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16934 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16937 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16940 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16943 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16944 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16948 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Main Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16949 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
16950 @include doclicense.texi
16953 @node Main Index, Key Index, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
16954 @unnumbered Concept index
16958 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16959 @unnumbered Key index
16963 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16964 @unnumbered Command and function index
16968 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16969 @unnumbered Variable index
16971 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16972 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16973 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16979 @c Local variables:
16981 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16982 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16983 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16987 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre